aboutsummaryrefslogtreecommitdiffstats
path: root/doc
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
Diffstat (limited to 'doc')
-rw-r--r--doc/.cvsignore2
-rw-r--r--doc/C/.cvsignore9
-rw-r--r--doc/C/Makefile.am59
-rw-r--r--doc/C/apx-authors.sgml75
-rw-r--r--doc/C/apx-bugs.sgml23
-rw-r--r--doc/C/apx-fdl.sgml466
-rw-r--r--doc/C/apx-gloss.sgml432
-rw-r--r--doc/C/apx-gpl.sgml414
-rw-r--r--doc/C/config-prefs.sgml647
-rw-r--r--doc/C/config-setupassist.sgml214
-rw-r--r--doc/C/config-sync.sgml58
-rw-r--r--doc/C/evolution-guide.sgml143
-rw-r--r--doc/C/fig/calendar.pngbin30227 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--doc/C/fig/config-cal.pngbin6898 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--doc/C/fig/config-mail.pngbin8680 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--doc/C/fig/contact-editor.pngbin37707 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--doc/C/fig/contact.pngbin27020 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--doc/C/fig/filter-assist-fig.pngbin6644 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--doc/C/fig/filter-new-fig.pngbin7826 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--doc/C/fig/mail-composer.pngbin15277 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--doc/C/fig/mail-druid-pic.pngbin35959 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--doc/C/fig/mail-inbox.pngbin31474 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--doc/C/fig/mainwindow-pic.pngbin166348 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--doc/C/fig/print-dest.pngbin7219 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--doc/C/fig/print-preview.pngbin26643 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--doc/C/fig/vfolder-createrule-fig.pngbin7621 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--doc/C/menuref.sgml1315
-rw-r--r--doc/C/preface.sgml427
-rw-r--r--doc/C/usage-calendar.sgml367
-rw-r--r--doc/C/usage-contact.sgml617
-rw-r--r--doc/C/usage-mail.sgml1382
-rw-r--r--doc/C/usage-mainwindow.sgml424
-rw-r--r--doc/C/usage-notes.sgml49
-rw-r--r--doc/C/usage-print.sgml92
-rw-r--r--doc/C/usage-sync.sgml20
-rw-r--r--doc/COPYING-DOCS355
-rw-r--r--doc/Camel-Classes35
-rw-r--r--doc/ChangeLog587
-rw-r--r--doc/Design201
-rw-r--r--doc/Keybindings13
-rw-r--r--doc/Makefile.am1
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/.cvsignore4
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/ChangeLog40
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/Makefile.am64
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/.cvsignore2
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/Makefile.am6
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/architecture.sgml94
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/.cvsignore3
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/Makefile.am76
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client-decl.txt132
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client-sections.txt37
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client.args0
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client.hierarchy2
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client.signals21
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client.types4
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/tmpl/cal-client.sgml294
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/tmpl/evolution-cal-client-unused.sgml10
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/.cvsignore3
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/Makefile.am75
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util-decl.txt852
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util-sections.txt166
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util.args0
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util.hierarchy2
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util.signals0
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util.types4
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/tmpl/cal-component.sgml934
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/tmpl/cal-recur.sgml88
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/tmpl/cal-util.sgml62
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/tmpl/evolution-cal-util-unused.sgml0
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/tmpl/timeutil.sgml260
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/evolution-calendar.sgml51
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/public-reference.sgml24
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/calendar/reference.sgml24
-rw-r--r--doc/devel/evolution-devel-guide.sgml50
-rw-r--r--doc/white-papers/calendar/calendar.sgml209
-rw-r--r--doc/white-papers/mail/camel.sgml339
-rw-r--r--doc/white-papers/mail/ibex.sgml158
-rw-r--r--doc/white-papers/widgets/e-table.sgml279
78 files changed, 0 insertions, 12796 deletions
diff --git a/doc/.cvsignore b/doc/.cvsignore
deleted file mode 100644
index 282522db03..0000000000
--- a/doc/.cvsignore
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,2 +0,0 @@
-Makefile
-Makefile.in
diff --git a/doc/C/.cvsignore b/doc/C/.cvsignore
deleted file mode 100644
index 2f4c48adbf..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/.cvsignore
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,9 +0,0 @@
-Makefile
-Makefile.in
-evolution-guide
-evolution-guide.junk
-evolution-guide.log
-evolution-guide.ps
-evolution-guide.dvi
-evolution-guide.tex
-fig/*.eps \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/doc/C/Makefile.am b/doc/C/Makefile.am
deleted file mode 100644
index 15f1e047b6..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/Makefile.am
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,59 +0,0 @@
-evolution_helpdir = $(datadir)/gnome/help/evolution/C
-
-SGML_FILES = \
- apx-authors.sgml \
- apx-bugs.sgml \
- apx-fdl.sgml \
- apx-gloss.sgml \
- config-prefs.sgml \
- config-setupassist.sgml \
- config-sync.sgml \
- evolution-guide.sgml \
- preface.sgml \
- usage-calendar.sgml \
- usage-contact.sgml \
- usage-mail.sgml \
- usage-mainwindow.sgml \
- usage-sync.sgml
-
-
-EXTRA_DIST = \
- $(SGML_FILES)
-
-all: evolution-guide
-
-evolution-guide: $(SGML_FILES)
- -db2html evolution-guide.sgml
-
-dist-hook:
- mkdir $(distdir)/evolution-guide
- -cp evolution-guide/*.html evolution-guide/*.css $(distdir)/evolution-guide
- mkdir $(distdir)/fig
- -cp fig/*.png $(distdir)/fig
- mkdir $(distdir)/evolution-guide/stylesheet-images
- -cp evolution-guide/stylesheet-images/* $(distdir)/evolution-guide/stylesheet-images
-
-install-data-local: evolution-guide
- $(top_srcdir)/mkinstalldirs $(DESTDIR)$(evolution_helpdir)
- -for file in $(srcdir)/evolution-guide/*.html $(srcdir)/evolution-guide/*.css; do \
- basefile=`basename $$file`; \
- $(INSTALL_DATA) $$file $(DESTDIR)$(evolution_helpdir)/$$basefile; \
- done
-
- $(top_srcdir)/mkinstalldirs $(DESTDIR)$(evolution_helpdir)/fig
- -for file in $(srcdir)/fig/*.png; do \
- basefile=`basename $$file`; \
- $(INSTALL_DATA) $$file $(DESTDIR)$(evolution_helpdir)/fig/$$basefile; \
- done
-
- $(top_srcdir)/mkinstalldirs $(DESTDIR)$(evolution_helpdir)/stylesheet-images
- -for file in $(srcdir)/evolution-guide/stylesheet-images/*; do \
- basefile=`basename $$file`; \
- $(INSTALL_DATA) $$file $(DESTDIR)$(evolution_helpdir)/stylesheet-images/$$basefile; \
- done
-
-evolution.ps: evolution.sgml
- -db2ps $<
-
-evolution.rtf: evolution.sgml
- -db2rtf $<
diff --git a/doc/C/apx-authors.sgml b/doc/C/apx-authors.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index 89f0dd6bc5..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/apx-authors.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,75 +0,0 @@
- <appendix id="authors">
- <title>Authors</title>
- <para>
- <application>Evolution</application> was written by:
-<simplelist>
- <member>Seth Alves: <email>alves@helixcode.com</email></member>
- <member>Anders Carlsson: <email>andersca@gnu.org</email></member>
- <member>Damon Chaplin: <email>damon@helixcode.com</email></member>
- <member>Clifford R. Conover: <email>rusty@zootweb.com</email></member>
- <member>Miguel De Icaza: <email>miguel@helixcode.com</email></member>
- <member> Radek Doulik: <email>rodo@helixcode.com</email></member>
- <member>Arturo Espinoza: <email>arturo@nucleu.unam.mx</email></member>
- <member>Larry Ewing: <email>lewing@helixcode.com</email></member>
- <member>Bertrand Guiheneuf: <email>bertrand@helixcode.com</email></member>
- <member>Tuomas Kuosmanen: <email>tigert@gimp.org</email></member>
- <member>Christopher J. Lahey: <email>clahey@helixcode.com</email></member>
- <member>Matthew Loper: <email>matt@loper.org</email></member>
- <member>Federico Mena: <email>federico@helixcode.com</email></member>
- <member>Eskil Heyn Olsen: <email>deity@eski.dk</email></member>
- <member>Nat Friedman: <email>nat@helixcode.com</email></member>
- <member>Ettore Perazzoli: <email>ettore@helixcode.com</email></member>
- <member>Jeffrey Stedfast: <email>jeff@helixcode.com</email></member>
- <member>Russell Steinthal: <email>rms39@columbia.edu</email></member>
- <member>Peter Teichman: <email>peter@helixcode.com</email></member>
- <member>Chris Toshok: <email>toshok@helixcode.com</email></member>
- <member>Peter Williams: <email>peter@newton.cx</email></member>
- <member>Dan Winship: <email>danw@helixcode.com</email></member>
- <member>Michael Zucchi: <email>notzed@helixcode.com</email></member>
-</simplelist>
-and other dedicated GNOME programmers.
-</para>
- <para>
- The <application>Evolution</application> code owes a great debt
- to the <application>GNOME-pim</application> and
- <application>GNOME-Calendar</application> applications, and to
- <application>KHTMLW</application>. The developers of
- <application>Evolution</application> acknowledge the efforts
- and contributions of all who worked on those projects.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- For more information please visit the
- <application>Evolution</application> <ulink
- url="http://www.helixcode.com/apps/evolution.php3"
- type="http">Web page</ulink>. Please send all comments,
- suggestions, and bug reports to the <ulink
- url="http://bugs.gnome.org" type="http">GNOME bug tracking
- database</ulink>. Instructions for submitting bug reports can be
- found on-line at <ulink
- url="http://bugs.gnome.org/Reporting.html" type="http">
- http://bugs.gnome.org/Reporting.html</ulink>. You can also use
- command <command>bug-buddy</command> for submitting bug reports.
- </para>
- <para>
- This manual was written by Aaron Weber
- (<email>aaron@helixcode.com</email>) and Kevin Breit
- (<email>battery841@mypad.com</email>) with the help of the
- application programmers and the GNOME Documentation Project.
- Please send all comments and suggestions regarding the manual to
- the GNOME Documentation Project at
- <email>docs@gnome.org</email>. You can also add your comments
- online by using <ulink type="http"
- url="http://www.gnome.org/gdp/doctable/">GNOME Documentation
- Status Table</ulink>.
- </para>
- <!-- For translations: uncomment this: <para> Latin translation
- was done by ME (<email>MYNAME@MYADDRESS</email>). Please send
- all comments and suggestions regarding this translation to
- SOMEWHERE. </para> -->
- </appendix>
-
-
-
-
-
diff --git a/doc/C/apx-bugs.sgml b/doc/C/apx-bugs.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index e4a96a8155..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/apx-bugs.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,23 +0,0 @@
- <appendix id="bugs">
-
- <title>Known bugs and limitations</title>
- <abstract>
- <para>
- This appendix describes known bugs and limitations of
- <application>Evolution</application>. Please use the GNOME
- <application>Bug Report Tool</application> (known as
- <command>bug-buddy</command> at the command line) if you find one
- we have not listed.
- </para>
- </abstract>
-
- <para>
- Evolution is still beta software, so the bug tracking is best
- left to the bugzilla system and to the programmers. However,
- there are a number of limitations that will not be addressed
- before version 1.0. The most notable are: Import of Microsoft
- Outlook .pst files, and compatibility with the Microsoft
- Exchange protocol.
- </para>
- </appendix>
-
diff --git a/doc/C/apx-fdl.sgml b/doc/C/apx-fdl.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index 17a3bf3070..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/apx-fdl.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,466 +0,0 @@
-<appendix id="fdl">
-<title>GNU Free Documentation License</title>
-<!-- - GNU Project - Free Software Foundation (FSF) -->
-<!-- LINK REV="made" HREF="mailto:webmasters@gnu.org" -->
-
-
- <sect1 id="fdl-version">
- <title>GNU Free Documentation License</title>
-
- <para>Version 1.1, March 2000</para>
-
- <blockquote>
- <para>Copyright (C) 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA
-Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
-of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.</para>
- </blockquote>
- </sect1>
- <sect1 id="fdl-preamble" label="0">
- <title>PREAMBLE</title>
-
- <para>The purpose of this License is to make a manual, textbook,
- or other written document "free" in the sense of freedom: to
- assure everyone the effective freedom to copy and redistribute it,
- with or without modifying it, either commercially or
- noncommercially. Secondarily, this License preserves for the
- author and publisher a way to get credit for their work, while not
- being considered responsible for modifications made by
- others.</para>
-
- <para>This License is a kind of "copyleft", which means that
- derivative works of the document must themselves be free in the
- same sense. It complements the GNU General Public License, which
- is a copyleft license designed for free software.</para>
-
- <para>We have designed this License in order to use it for manuals
- for free software, because free software needs free documentation:
- a free program should come with manuals providing the same
- freedoms that the software does. But this License is not limited
- to software manuals; it can be used for any textual work,
- regardless of subject matter or whether it is published as a
- printed book. We recommend this License principally for works
- whose purpose is instruction or reference.</para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="fdl-applicability" label="1">
- <title>APPLICABILITY AND DEFINITIONS</title>
-
- <para>This License applies to any manual or other work that
- contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it can be
- distributed under the terms of this License. The "Document",
- below, refers to any such manual or work. Any member of the
- public is a licensee, and is addressed as "you".</para>
-
- <para>A "Modified Version" of the Document means any work
- containing the Document or a portion of it, either copied
- verbatim, or with modifications and/or translated into another
- language.</para>
-
- <para>A "Secondary Section" is a named appendix or a front-matter
- section of the Document that deals exclusively with the
- relationship of the publishers or authors of the Document to the
- Document's overall subject (or to related matters) and contains
- nothing that could fall directly within that overall subject.
- (For example, if the Document is in part a textbook of
- mathematics, a Secondary Section may not explain any mathematics.)
- The relationship could be a matter of historical connection with
- the subject or with related matters, or of legal, commercial,
- philosophical, ethical or political position regarding
- them.</para>
-
- <para>The "Invariant Sections" are certain Secondary Sections
- whose titles are designated, as being those of Invariant Sections,
- in the notice that says that the Document is released under this
- License.</para>
-
- <para>The "Cover Texts" are certain short passages of text that
- are listed, as Front-Cover Texts or Back-Cover Texts, in the
- notice that says that the Document is released under this
- License.</para>
-
- <para>A "Transparent" copy of the Document means a
- machine-readable copy, represented in a format whose specification
- is available to the general public, whose contents can be viewed
- and edited directly and straightforwardly with generic text
- editors or (for images composed of pixels) generic paint programs
- or (for drawings) some widely available drawing editor, and that
- is suitable for input to text formatters or for automatic
- translation to a variety of formats suitable for input to text
- formatters. A copy made in an otherwise Transparent file format
- whose markup has been designed to thwart or discourage subsequent
- modification by readers is not Transparent. A copy that is not
- "Transparent" is called "Opaque".</para>
-
- <para>Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include
- plain ASCII without markup, Texinfo input format, LaTeX input
- format, SGML or XML using a publicly available DTD, and
- standard-conforming simple HTML designed for human modification.
- Opaque formats include PostScript, PDF, proprietary formats that
- can be read and edited only by proprietary word processors, SGML
- or XML for which the DTD and/or processing tools are not generally
- available, and the machine-generated HTML produced by some word
- processors for output purposes only.</para>
-
- <para>The "Title Page" means, for a printed book, the title page
- itself, plus such following pages as are needed to hold, legibly,
- the material this License requires to appear in the title page.
- For works in formats which do not have any title page as such,
- "Title Page" means the text near the most prominent appearance of
- the work's title, preceding the beginning of the body of the
- text.</para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 label="2">
- <title>VERBATIM COPYING</title>
-
- <para>You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium,
- either commercially or noncommercially, provided that this
- License, the copyright notices, and the license notice saying this
- License applies to the Document are reproduced in all copies, and
- that you add no other conditions whatsoever to those of this
- License. You may not use technical measures to obstruct or
- control the reading or further copying of the copies you make or
- distribute. However, you may accept compensation in exchange for
- copies. If you distribute a large enough number of copies you
- must also follow the conditions in section 3.</para>
-
- <para>You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated
- above, and you may publicly display copies.</para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 label="3">
- <title>COPYING IN QUANTITY</title>
-
- <para>If you publish printed copies of the Document numbering more
- than 100, and the Document's license notice requires Cover Texts,
- you must enclose the copies in covers that carry, clearly and
- legibly, all these Cover Texts: Front-Cover Texts on the front
- cover, and Back-Cover Texts on the back cover. Both covers must
- also clearly and legibly identify you as the publisher of these
- copies. The front cover must present the full title with all
- words of the title equally prominent and visible. You may add
- other material on the covers in addition. Copying with changes
- limited to the covers, as long as they preserve the title of the
- Document and satisfy these conditions, can be treated as verbatim
- copying in other respects.</para>
-
- <para>If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to
- fit legibly, you should put the first ones listed (as many as fit
- reasonably) on the actual cover, and continue the rest onto
- adjacent pages.</para>
-
- <para>If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document
- numbering more than 100, you must either include a
- machine-readable Transparent copy along with each Opaque copy, or
- state in or with each Opaque copy a publicly-accessible
- computer-network location containing a complete Transparent copy
- of the Document, free of added material, which the general
- network-using public has access to download anonymously at no
- charge using public-standard network protocols. If you use the
- latter option, you must take reasonably prudent steps, when you
- begin distribution of Opaque copies in quantity, to ensure that
- this Transparent copy will remain thus accessible at the stated
- location until at least one year after the last time you
- distribute an Opaque copy (directly or through your agents or
- retailers) of that edition to the public.</para>
-
- <para>It is requested, but not required, that you contact the
- authors of the Document well before redistributing any large
- number of copies, to give them a chance to provide you with an
- updated version of the Document.</para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 label="4">
- <title>MODIFICATIONS</title>
-
- <para>You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the
- Document under the conditions of sections 2 and 3 above, provided
- that you release the Modified Version under precisely this
- License, with the Modified Version filling the role of the
- Document, thus licensing distribution and modification of the
- Modified Version to whoever possesses a copy of it. In addition,
- you must do these things in the Modified Version:</para>
-
- <orderedlist numeration="upperalpha">
- <listitem><para>Use in the Title Page
- (and on the covers, if any) a title distinct from that of the
- Document, and from those of previous versions (which should, if
- there were any, be listed in the History section of the
- Document). You may use the same title as a previous version if
- the original publisher of that version gives permission.</para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>List on the Title Page,
- as authors, one or more persons or entities responsible for
- authorship of the modifications in the Modified Version,
- together with at least five of the principal authors of the
- Document (all of its principal authors, if it has less than
- five).</para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>State on the Title page
- the name of the publisher of the Modified Version, as the
- publisher.</para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>Preserve all the
- copyright notices of the Document.</para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>Add an appropriate
- copyright notice for your modifications adjacent to the other
- copyright notices.</para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>Include, immediately
- after the copyright notices, a license notice giving the public
- permission to use the Modified Version under the terms of this
- License, in the form shown in the Addendum below.</para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>Preserve in that license
- notice the full lists of Invariant Sections and required Cover
- Texts given in the Document's license notice.</para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>Include an unaltered
- copy of this License.</para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>Preserve the section
- entitled "History", and its title, and add to it an item stating
- at least the title, year, new authors, and publisher of the
- Modified Version as given on the Title Page. If there is no
- section entitled "History" in the Document, create one stating
- the title, year, authors, and publisher of the Document as given
- on its Title Page, then add an item describing the Modified
- Version as stated in the previous sentence.</para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>Preserve the network
- location, if any, given in the Document for public access to a
- Transparent copy of the Document, and likewise the network
- locations given in the Document for previous versions it was
- based on. These may be placed in the "History" section. You
- may omit a network location for a work that was published at
- least four years before the Document itself, or if the original
- publisher of the version it refers to gives permission.</para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>In any section entitled
- "Acknowledgements" or "Dedications", preserve the section's
- title, and preserve in the section all the substance and tone of
- each of the contributor acknowledgements and/or dedications
- given therein.</para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>Preserve all the
- Invariant Sections of the Document, unaltered in their text and
- in their titles. Section numbers or the equivalent are not
- considered part of the section titles.</para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>Delete any section
- entitled "Endorsements". Such a section may not be included in
- the Modified Version.</para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>Do not retitle any
- existing section as "Endorsements" or to conflict in title with
- any Invariant Section.</para>
- </listitem>
- </orderedlist>
-
- <para>If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections
- or appendices that qualify as Secondary Sections and contain no
- material copied from the Document, you may at your option
- designate some or all of these sections as invariant. To do this,
- add their titles to the list of Invariant Sections in the Modified
- Version's license notice. These titles must be distinct from any
- other section titles.</para>
-
- <para>You may add a section entitled "Endorsements", provided it
- contains nothing but endorsements of your Modified Version by
- various parties--for example, statements of peer review or that
- the text has been approved by an organization as the authoritative
- definition of a standard.</para>
-
- <para>You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover
- Text, and a passage of up to 25 words as a Back-Cover Text, to the
- end of the list of Cover Texts in the Modified Version. Only one
- passage of Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover Text may be
- added by (or through arrangements made by) any one entity. If the
- Document already includes a cover text for the same cover,
- previously added by you or by arrangement made by the same entity
- you are acting on behalf of, you may not add another; but you may
- replace the old one, on explicit permission from the previous
- publisher that added the old one.</para>
-
- <para>The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by
- this License give permission to use their names for publicity for
- or to assert or imply endorsement of any Modified Version.</para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 label="5">
- <title>COMBINING DOCUMENTS</title>
-
- <para>You may combine the Document with other documents released
- under this License, under the terms defined in section 4 above for
- modified versions, provided that you include in the combination
- all of the Invariant Sections of all of the original documents,
- unmodified, and list them all as Invariant Sections of your
- combined work in its license notice.</para>
-
- <para>The combined work need only contain one copy of this
- License, and multiple identical Invariant Sections may be replaced
- with a single copy. If there are multiple Invariant Sections with
- the same name but different contents, make the title of each such
- section unique by adding at the end of it, in parentheses, the
- name of the original author or publisher of that section if known,
- or else a unique number. Make the same adjustment to the section
- titles in the list of Invariant Sections in the license notice of
- the combined work.</para>
-
- <para>In the combination, you must combine any sections entitled
- "History" in the various original documents, forming one section
- entitled "History"; likewise combine any sections entitled
- "Acknowledgements", and any sections entitled "Dedications". You
- must delete all sections entitled "Endorsements."</para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 label="6">
- <title>COLLECTIONS OF DOCUMENTS</title>
-
- <para>You may make a collection consisting of the Document and
- other documents released under this License, and replace the
- individual copies of this License in the various documents with a
- single copy that is included in the collection, provided that you
- follow the rules of this License for verbatim copying of each of
- the documents in all other respects.</para>
-
- <para>You may extract a single document from such a collection,
- and distribute it individually under this License, provided you
- insert a copy of this License into the extracted document, and
- follow this License in all other respects regarding verbatim
- copying of that document.</para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 label="7">
- <title>AGGREGATION WITH INDEPENDENT WORKS</title>
-
- <para>A compilation of the Document or its derivatives with other
- separate and independent documents or works, in or on a volume of
- a storage or distribution medium, does not as a whole count as a
- Modified Version of the Document, provided no compilation
- copyright is claimed for the compilation. Such a compilation is
- called an "aggregate", and this License does not apply to the
- other self-contained works thus compiled with the Document, on
- account of their being thus compiled, if they are not themselves
- derivative works of the Document.</para>
-
- <para>If the Cover Text requirement of section 3 is applicable to
- these copies of the Document, then if the Document is less than
- one quarter of the entire aggregate, the Document's Cover Texts
- may be placed on covers that surround only the Document within the
- aggregate. Otherwise they must appear on covers around the whole
- aggregate.</para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 label="8">
- <title>TRANSLATION</title>
-
- <para>Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may
- distribute translations of the Document under the terms of section
- 4. Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires
- special permission from their copyright holders, but you may
- include translations of some or all Invariant Sections in addition
- to the original versions of these Invariant Sections. You may
- include a translation of this License provided that you also
- include the original English version of this License. In case of
- a disagreement between the translation and the original English
- version of this License, the original English version will
- prevail.</para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 label="9">
- <title>TERMINATION</title>
-
- <para>You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the
- Document except as expressly provided for under this License. Any
- other attempt to copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the
- Document is void, and will automatically terminate your rights
- under this License. However, parties who have received copies, or
- rights, from you under this License will not have their licenses
- terminated so long as such parties remain in full
- compliance.</para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 label="10">
- <title>FUTURE REVISIONS OF THIS LICENSE</title>
-
- <para>The Free Software Foundation may publish new, revised
- versions of the GNU Free Documentation License from time to time.
- Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present
- version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or
- concerns. See <ulink
- url="http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/">http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/</ulink>.</para>
-
- <para>Each version of the License is given a distinguishing
- version number. If the Document specifies that a particular
- numbered version of this License "or any later version" applies to
- it, you have the option of following the terms and conditions
- either of that specified version or of any later version that has
- been published (not as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation.
- If the Document does not specify a version number of this License,
- you may choose any version ever published (not as a draft) by the
- Free Software Foundation.</para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 label="">
- <title>How to use this License for your documents</title>
-
- <para>To use this License in a document you have written, include
- a copy of the License in the document and put the following
- copyright and license notices just after the title page:</para>
-
-<blockquote><para>
- Copyright (c) YEAR YOUR NAME.
- Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
- under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1
- or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
- with the Invariant Sections being LIST THEIR TITLES, with the
- Front-Cover Texts being LIST, and with the Back-Cover Texts being LIST.
- A copy of the license is included in the section entitled "GNU
- Free Documentation License".
-</para></blockquote>
-
- <para>If you have no Invariant Sections, write "with no Invariant
- Sections" instead of saying which ones are invariant. If you have
- no Front-Cover Texts, write "no Front-Cover Texts" instead of
- "Front-Cover Texts being LIST"; likewise for Back-Cover
- Texts.</para>
-
- <para>If your document contains nontrivial examples of program
- code, we recommend releasing these examples in parallel under your
- choice of free software license, such as the GNU General Public
- License, to permit their use in free software.</para>
- </sect1>
-
-</appendix>
-<!-- Keep this comment at the end of the file
-Local variables:
-mode: sgml
-sgml-omittag:nil
-sgml-shorttag:t
-sgml-minimize-attributes:nil
-sgml-always-quote-attributes:t
-sgml-indent-step:2
-sgml-parent-document: ("referenz.sgml" "appendix")
-sgml-exposed-tags:nil
-sgml-local-ecat-files:nil
-sgml-local-catalogs: CATALOG
-sgml-validate-command: "nsgmls -s referenz.sgml"
-ispell-skip-sgml: t
-End:
--->
diff --git a/doc/C/apx-gloss.sgml b/doc/C/apx-gloss.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index f04b381d19..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/apx-gloss.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,432 +0,0 @@
-<glossary id="apx-gloss">
-
- <title>Glossary</title>
-
- <glossentry id="attachment">
- <glossterm>Attachment</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- Any file sent along with an email. Attachments may be embedded in
- a message or appended to it.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
-<glossentry id="automatic-indexing">
- <glossterm>Automatic Indexing</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- Pre-sorting procedure that allows
- <application>Evolution</application> to refer to data quickly.
- It enables faster searches and decreases memory usage for
- data displays.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="bcc">
- <glossterm>Bcc (Blind Carbon Copy)</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- A way of addressing a message. Bcc is used to send a group of
- people an e-mail, while hiding their names and addresses from each
- other.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="cc">
- <glossterm>Cc (Carbon Copy)</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- Carbon-copies are used to send a 3rd party a copy of the e-mail,
- so they an keep up to date on a conversation, without being in the
- To: list.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="druid">
- <glossterm>Druid</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- A tool which guides a user through a series of steps, usually to
- configure or set up a program. Equivalent to "Assistant" and
- "Wizard."
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
-<glossentry id="emoticon">
- <glossterm>Emoticon</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- Also called "smileys," emoticons are the little sideways faces made
- of colons and parentheses which people use to convey emotion in email.
- Examples: :-) or ;( .
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="evolution">
- <glossterm>Evolution</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- <application>Evolution</application> is the <acronym> GNOME
- </acronym> groupware application.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="execute">
- <glossterm>Execute</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- To run a program. Any file that can be run is called an
- executable. <application>Evolution</application> can download
- executable attachments, but before they can be run, the files must
- be marked as executable with a shell or file manager. This
- security precaution prevents the automatic or accidental execution
- of malicious programs. For more information on executables and file
- permissions, see the documentation for your file manager or shell.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
-
- <glossentry id="filetree">
- <glossterm>File Tree</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- A way of describing a group of files on a computer. With the
- perversity typical of computer (and especially Unix and Linux)
- nomenclature, the top of the tree is called the root directory,
- and denoted by <systemitem><filename>/</filename></systemitem>.
- The rest of the "branches" spread downwards from the root. Don't
- confuse the root directory with the <systemitem>root</systemitem>
- account, or root's home directory,
- <systemitem><filename>/home/root</filename></systemitem>.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="filter">
- <glossterm>Filter</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- Within <application>Evolution</application>, a filter is a method
- of sorting mail automatically. You can create filters to perform
- one or more actions on a message that meets any (or all) of a wide
- range of criteria.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="forward">
- <glossterm>Forward</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- the user can send a third party a message
- which was sent to the user originally.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="groupware">
- <glossterm>Groupware</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- Groupware is a term describing an application which helps groups
- of people work together. Typically, a groupware application will
- have several productivity features built into one program.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="haiku">
- <glossterm>Haiku</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- A traditional Japanese form of poetry. The poems are three lines
- long, with first and last lines having five syllables, and the
- second line seven syllables.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="html">
- <glossterm>HTML</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- Hyper-text Markup Language(<acronym>HTML</acronym>) is a language
- for describing page layout in electronic documents like web pages,
- help files, and email messages. HTML can be used in email and
- news posts to insert images and apply text treatments.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="hot-key">
- <glossterm>Hot Key</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- Hot-keys are keyboard combinations used to do actions on a
- computer instead of using the mouse to do the same action.
- Hot-keys can speed up computer usage.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="ical">
- <glossterm>iCal</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- <application>iCal</application> is the program which
- <application>Evolution</application> uses to manage the calendar
- section.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="imap">
- <glossterm>IMAP</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- Depending upon whom you ask, IMAP stands for the Internet Mail
- Access Protocol, or the Interim Mail Access Protocol. Whatever it
- stands for, it allows access to email which is typically (although
- not always) stored remotely on a server rather than on a local
- hard disk. Often contrasted with <glossterm>POP</glossterm>.
- This will not be on the test.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
-
- <glossentry id="inline">
- <glossterm>Inline</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- Displayed as part of a message or other document, rather than
- attached as a separate file. Contrast with <glossterm
- linkend="attachment">Attachment</glossterm>.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="ldap">
- <glossterm>LDAP</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- LDAP, the Lightweight Directory Access Protocol, allows a client
- to search through a large database of addresses, phone numbers,
- and people stored on a server.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="mail-client">
- <glossterm>Mail Client</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- A mail client is the application with which a person reads and
- sends e-mail. Its counterparts are the various types of mail
- servers, which handle user authentication and direct messages from
- sender to recipient.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
-
- <glossentry id="minicard">
- <glossterm>Minicard</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- A format for the display of contact data. Similar in appearance
- to a small business card.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="nautilus">
- <glossterm>Nautilus</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- <application>Nautilus</application> is the next generation file
- manager for <acronym>GNOME</acronym> being written by Eazel.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="nickname">
- <glossterm>Nickname</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- An alias for an e-mail address.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="pop">
- <glossterm>POP</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- POP, the Post Office Protocol, is a mechanism for email
- transport. In contrast to IMAP, it is used only to get mail from
- a server and store it locally on your hard disk.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="protocol">
- <glossterm>Protocol</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- An agreed-upon method of communication, especially one for
- sending particular types of information between computer systems.
- Examples include POP (Post Office Protocol), for email, and HTTP
- (HypterText Transfer Protocol), for web pages.
-
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
-
- <glossentry id="regular-expression">
- <glossterm>Regular Expression</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- A regular expression, or "regex", is a way of describing a
- string of text using metacharacters or wild-card symbols. For
- example, the statement <userinput>fly*so[a|u]p</userinput> means
- "any phrase beginning with 'fly' and ending in 'soup' or
- 'soap'". If you searched for that expression, you'd find both
- "fly in my soup" and "fly in my soap." There's not room here to
- go into depth, but if you want, have a look at the documentation
- for the <command>grep</command> command.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="script">
- <glossterm>Script</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- A program written in an interpreted (rather than compiled)
- language. Often used as a synonym for "macro," to denote a series
- of pre-recorded commands or actions within an application.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="sendmail">
- <glossterm>Sendmail</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- As its name implies, <application>sendmail</application> is a
- program which sends mail. <application>Evolution</application>
- can use it instead of <glossterm>SMTP</glossterm>; some people
- prefer it because it offers more flexibility, but is more
- difficult to set up.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
-
- <glossentry id="shortcut-bar">
- <glossterm>Shortcut Bar</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- A portion of <application>Evolution</application> which offers
- users fast access to the most frequently used portions of the
- application.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="signature">
- <glossterm>Signature</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- In email terms, a signature is a piece of text placed at the end
- of every email sent, like a hand-written signature at the bottom
- of a written letter. A signature can be anything from a favorite
- quotation to a link to a web page; courtesy dictates that it be
- fewer than four lines long.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="SMTP">
- <glossterm>SMTP</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- This is the most common way of transporting mail messages from
- the client's computer (you) to the server. SMTP stands for
- Simple Mail Transfer Protocol.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="spam">
- <glossterm>Spam</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- Useless, unwanted e-mail. Spam normally comes in forms of
- chain-letters and advertisements for unscrupulous web sites or
- services. Messages that are merely useless are called "opt-in
- newsletters."
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="virus">
- <glossterm>Virus</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- A malicious program which inserts itself into others so that it will be
- executed, allowing it to spread to still more programs and other computers.
- A virus can cause substantial damage by clogging networks or disk drives,
- deleting files, or opening security holes.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="vcard">
- <glossterm>vCard</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- A file format for the exchange of contact information. When you
- get an address card attached to an email, it's probably in vCard
- format. Not to be confused with <glossterm
- linkend="vfolder">vFolder</glossterm>.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
- <glossentry id="vfolder">
- <glossterm>vFolder</glossterm>
- <glossdef>
- <para>
- An email organization tool. vFolders allows you to create a folder
- that contains the results of a complex search. Folder contents are
- are updated dynamically.
- </para>
- </glossdef>
- </glossentry>
-
-</glossary>
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
diff --git a/doc/C/apx-gpl.sgml b/doc/C/apx-gpl.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index 7c7e4cd0f7..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/apx-gpl.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,414 +0,0 @@
-<appendix id="gpl">
- <title>GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE</title>
- <subtitle>Version 2, June 1991</subtitle>
-
-
-<para>
-
- Copyright (C) 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
- 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA
- Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
- of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
-</para>
-<sect1>
-<title>Preamble</title>
-<para>
- The licenses for most software are designed to take away your
-freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public
-License is intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free
-software--to make sure the software is free for all its users. This
-General Public License applies to most of the Free Software
-Foundation's software and to any other program whose authors commit to
-using it. (Some other Free Software Foundation software is covered by
-the GNU Library General Public License instead.) You can apply it to
-your programs, too.
-</para>
-<para>
- When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not
-price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you
-have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for
-this service if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it
-if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it
-in new free programs; and that you know you can do these things.
-</para>
-<para>
- To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid
-anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender the rights.
-These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you
-distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it.
-</para>
-<para>
- For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether
-gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that
-you have. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the
-source code. And you must show them these terms so they know their
-rights.
-</para>
-<para>
- We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the software, and
-(2) offer you this license which gives you legal permission to copy,
-distribute and/or modify the software.
-</para>
-<para>
- Also, for each author's protection and ours, we want to make certain
-that everyone understands that there is no warranty for this free
-software. If the software is modified by someone else and passed on, we
-want its recipients to know that what they have is not the original, so
-that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on the original
-authors' reputations.
-</para>
-<para>
- Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by software
-patents. We wish to avoid the danger that redistributors of a free
-program will individually obtain patent licenses, in effect making the
-program proprietary. To prevent this, we have made it clear that any
-patent must be licensed for everyone's free use or not licensed at all.
-</para>
-<para>
- The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and
-modification follow.
-</para>
-
-</sect1>
-
-<sect1>
-<title> GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
- TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION</title>
-<para>
- 0. This License applies to any program or other work which contains
-a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it may be distributed
-under the terms of this General Public License. The "Program", below,
-refers to any such program or work, and a "work based on the Program"
-means either the Program or any derivative work under copyright law:
-that is to say, a work containing the Program or a portion of it,
-either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated into another
-language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without limitation in
-the term "modification".) Each licensee is addressed as "you".
-</para>
-<para>
-Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not
-covered by this License; they are outside its scope. The act of
-running the Program is not restricted, and the output from the Program
-is covered only if its contents constitute a work based on the
-Program (independent of having been made by running the Program).
-Whether that is true depends on what the Program does.
-</para>
-<para>
- 1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Program's
-source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you
-conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate
-copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact all the
-notices that refer to this License and to the absence of any warranty;
-and give any other recipients of the Program a copy of this License
-along with the Program.
-</para>
-<para>
-You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and
-you may at your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee.
-</para>
-<para>
- 2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or any portion
-of it, thus forming a work based on the Program, and copy and
-distribute such modifications or work under the terms of Section 1
-above, provided that you also meet all of these conditions:
-</para>
-<para>
- a) You must cause the modified files to carry prominent notices
- stating that you changed the files and the date of any change.
-</para>
-<para>
- b) You must cause any work that you distribute or publish, that in
- whole or in part contains or is derived from the Program or any
- part thereof, to be licensed as a whole at no charge to all third
- parties under the terms of this License.
-</para>
-<para>
- c) If the modified program normally reads commands interactively
- when run, you must cause it, when started running for such
- interactive use in the most ordinary way, to print or display an
- announcement including an appropriate copyright notice and a
- notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that you provide
- a warranty) and that users may redistribute the program under
- these conditions, and telling the user how to view a copy of this
- License. (Exception: if the Program itself is interactive but
- does not normally print such an announcement, your work based on
- the Program is not required to print an announcement.)
-</para>
-<para>
-These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If
-identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the Program,
-and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in
-themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not apply to those
-sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you
-distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based
-on the Program, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of
-this License, whose permissions for other licensees extend to the
-entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote it.
-</para>
-<para>
-Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest
-your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to
-exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or
-collective works based on the Program.
-</para>
-<para>
-In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Program
-with the Program (or with a work based on the Program) on a volume of
-a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under
-the scope of this License.
-</para>
-<para>
- 3. You may copy and distribute the Program (or a work based on it,
-under Section 2) in object code or executable form under the terms of
-Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you also do one of the following:
-</para>
-<para>
- a) Accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable
- source code, which must be distributed under the terms of Sections
- 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange; or,
-</para>
-<para>
- b) Accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least three
- years, to give any third party, for a charge no more than your
- cost of physically performing source distribution, a complete
- machine-readable copy of the corresponding source code, to be
- distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium
- customarily used for software interchange; or,
-</para>
-<para>
- c) Accompany it with the information you received as to the offer
- to distribute corresponding source code. (This alternative is
- allowed only for noncommercial distribution and only if you
- received the program in object code or executable form with such
- an offer, in accord with Subsection b above.)
-</para>
-<para>
-The source code for a work means the preferred form of the work for
-making modifications to it. For an executable work, complete source
-code means all the source code for all modules it contains, plus any
-associated interface definition files, plus the scripts used to
-control compilation and installation of the executable. However, as a
-special exception, the source code distributed need not include
-anything that is normally distributed (in either source or binary
-form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the
-operating system on which the executable runs, unless that component
-itself accompanies the executable.
-</para>
-<para>
-If distribution of executable or object code is made by offering
-access to copy from a designated place, then offering equivalent
-access to copy the source code from the same place counts as
-distribution of the source code, even though third parties are not
-compelled to copy the source along with the object code.
-</para>
-<para>
- 4. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Program
-except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt
-otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Program is
-void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License.
-However, parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under
-this License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such
-parties remain in full compliance.
-</para>
-<para>
- 5. You are not required to accept this License, since you have not
-signed it. However, nothing else grants you permission to modify or
-distribute the Program or its derivative works. These actions are
-prohibited by law if you do not accept this License. Therefore, by
-modifying or distributing the Program (or any work based on the
-Program), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and
-all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying
-the Program or works based on it.
-</para>
-<para>
- 6. Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work based on the
-Program), the recipient automatically receives a license from the
-original licensor to copy, distribute or modify the Program subject to
-these terms and conditions. You may not impose any further
-restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein.
-You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties to
-this License.
-</para>
-<para>
- 7. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent
-infringement or for any other reason (not limited to patent issues),
-conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or
-otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not
-excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot
-distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this
-License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you
-may not distribute the Program at all. For example, if a patent
-license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the Program by
-all those who receive copies directly or indirectly through you, then
-the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be to
-refrain entirely from distribution of the Program.
-</para>
-<para>
-If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under
-any particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to
-apply and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other
-circumstances.
-</para>
-<para>
-It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any
-patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of any
-such claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the
-integrity of the free software distribution system, which is
-implemented by public license practices. Many people have made
-generous contributions to the wide range of software distributed
-through that system in reliance on consistent application of that
-system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing
-to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot
-impose that choice.
-</para>
-<para>
-This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to
-be a consequence of the rest of this License.
-</para>
-<para>
- 8. If the distribution and/or use of the Program is restricted in
-certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the
-original copyright holder who places the Program under this License
-may add an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding
-those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or among
-countries not thus excluded. In such case, this License incorporates
-the limitation as if written in the body of this License.
-</para>
-<para>
- 9. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions
-of the General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will
-be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to
-address new problems or concerns.
-</para>
-<para>
-Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program
-specifies a version number of this License which applies to it and "any
-later version", you have the option of following the terms and conditions
-either of that version or of any later version published by the Free
-Software Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of
-this License, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software
-Foundation.
-</para>
-<para>
- 10. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into other free
-programs whose distribution conditions are different, write to the author
-to ask for permission. For software which is copyrighted by the Free
-Software Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes
-make exceptions for this. Our decision will be guided by the two goals
-of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free software and
-of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally.
-</para>
-</sect1>
-<sect1>
-<title>NO WARRANTY</title>
-<para>
- 11. BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY
-FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN
-OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES
-PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED
-OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
-MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS
-TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE
-PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING,
-REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
-</para>
-<para>
- 12. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING
-WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR
-REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES,
-INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING
-OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED
-TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY
-YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER
-PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
-POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
-</para>
-<para>
- END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
-</para>
-</sect1>
- <sect1>
- <title>How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs</title>
-<para>
- If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest
-possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it
-free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms.
-</para>
-<para>
- To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest
-to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively
-convey the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least
-the "copyright" line and a pointer to where the full notice is found.
-</para>
-<para>
- &lt;one line to give the program's name and a brief idea of what it does.&gt;
-Copyright (C) &lt; year&gt; &lt;name of author&gt;
-</para>
-<para>
- This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
- it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
- the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
- (at your option) any later version.
-</para>
-<para>
- This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
- but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
- MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
- GNU General Public License for more details.
-</para>
-<para>
- You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
- along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
- Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA
-</para>
-<para>
-
-Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
-</para>
-<para>
-If the program is interactive, make it output a short notice like this
-when it starts in an interactive mode:
-</para>
-<para>
- Gnomovision version 69, Copyright (C) year name of author
- Gnomovision comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type `show w'.
- This is free software, and you are welcome to redistribute it
- under certain conditions; type `show c' for details.
-</para>
-<para>
-The hypothetical commands `show w' and `show c' should show the appropriate
-parts of the General Public License. Of course, the commands you use may
-be called something other than `show w' and `show c'; they could even be
-mouse-clicks or menu items--whatever suits your program.
-</para>
-<para>
-You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or your
-school, if any, to sign a "copyright disclaimer" for the program, if
-necessary. Here is a sample; alter the names:
-</para>
-<para>
- Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in the program
- `Gnomovision' (which makes passes at compilers) written by James Hacker.
-</para>
-<para>
- &lt;signature of Ty Coon&gt;, 1 April 1989
- Ty Coon, President of Vice
-</para>
-<para>
-This General Public License does not permit incorporating your program into
-proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you may
-consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with the
-library. If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Library General
-Public License instead of this License.
-</para>
-</sect1>
-</appendix>
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
diff --git a/doc/C/config-prefs.sgml b/doc/C/config-prefs.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index 27c1ac57db..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/config-prefs.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,647 +0,0 @@
-<!-- <!DOCTYPE Chapter PUBLIC "-//GNOME//DTD DocBook PNG Variant V1.1//EN"> -->
-
-<chapter id="config-prefs">
-
- <title>Advanced Configuration</title>
- <para>
- Perhaps your mail server has changed names. Perhaps you've
- grown tired of a certain layout for your appointments.
- Whatever the reason, you want to change your
- <application>Evolution</application> settings. This chapter
- will tell you how to do just that.
- </para>
-
- <sect1 id="config-prefs-mail">
- <title>Mail Settings</title>
- <para>
- To change your mail settings, select <menuchoice>
- <guimenu>Settings</guimenu> <guimenuitem>Mail
- configuration</guimenuitem></menuchoice> in the Inbox. This
- will open the <interface>mail preferences window</interface>,
- illustrated in <xref linkend="config-prefs-mail-fig">. Mail
- preferences are separated into several categories:
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Identities</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- This allows you to create and alter one or more
- identities for your email.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Sources</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- This tab lets you tell
- <application>Evolution</application> where to get the
- mail sent to you, and how to get it.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
-
- <term><guilabel>Mail Transport</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- This tab lets you tell
- <application>Evolution</application> how to send mail.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>News Servers</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- If you would like to use
- <application>Evolution</application> to read newsgroups,
- you can specify your news server preferences here.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Other</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Miscellaneous mail and news settings, such as HTML
- handling preferences, and how long
- <application>Evolution</application> should wait before
- marking message read.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
-
- </para>
-
- <!-- ==============Figure===================== -->
- <figure id="config-prefs-mail-fig">
- <title>Mail Preferences Dialog</title>
- <screenshot>
- <screeninfo>Setting mail preferences</screeninfo>
- <graphic fileref="fig/config-mail" format="png" srccredit="Aaron Weber">
- </graphic>
- </screenshot>
- </figure>
- <!-- ==============End of Figure================-->
-
-
- <sect2 id="config-prefs-mail-identity">
- <title>Identity Settings</title>
- <para>
- If you have only one email account, or send email from only
- one address, you will only need to configure one identity. If
- you want, however, you can have multiple identities. This
- can be useful if you want to keep personal and professional
- email separate, or if you wear several hats at work.
-
- </para>
- <para>
- To add a new identity, simply click
- <guibutton>Add</guibutton>. To alter an existing identity,
- click on it in the <guilabel>Identity</guilabel> tab of the
- <interface>Preferences</interface> window, and then click
- <guibutton>Edit</guibutton>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- <application>Evolution</application> will then present you
- with a dialog box containing four fields:
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <guilabel>Full Name:</guilabel> by default, this is the
- same name as the full name described in your user
- account on your computer. You can select another if you
- wish.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <guilabel>Email address:</guilabel> Enter your email
- address in this space.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <guilabel>Organization:</guilabel> If you send email as
- a representative of a company or other organization,
- enter its name here.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <guilabel>Signature file:</guilabel> You may choose a
- small text file to be appended to every message that you
- send. Typically, signature files include address or
- other contact information, or a favorite quotation.
- It's good form to keep it to four lines at the maximum.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="config-prefs-mail-network">
- <title>Network Settings</title>
- <para>
- In order to send mail with
- <application>Evolution</application>, you need to connect to
- your network. To do that, you'll need to know your user name
- and password, what sort of mail sending and receiving
- protocols your network uses, and the names of the servers
- you'll be using. If you're switching from another groupware
- or email program, you can almost certainly use the same
- settings as you did with that program. Network-related
- settings are in the <guilabel>Mail Sources</guilabel> and
- <guilabel>Mail Transport</guilabel> tabs.
- </para>
-
- <sect3 id="config-prefs-network-sources">
- <title>Mail Sources</title>
- <para>
- The <interface>Mail Sources</interface> tab allows you to
- edit, add, or delete methods of retrieving mail from
- servers. Clicking on <guibutton>Add</guibutton> or
- <guibutton>Edit</guibutton> will bring up a dialog box to
- offer you the following options:
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Mail source type:</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Select from IMAP or POP servers, or Unix-style
- <systemitem><filename>mbox</filename></systemitem>
- or <systemitem><filename>mh</filename></systemitem>
- files.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term> <guilabel>Server:</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Enter the name of the mail source server in this
- field. If you use an may or may not be the same as your
- <glossterm>SMTP</glossterm> server.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Username:</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Enter the user name for the account you have on the
- server-- this should the part of your email address
- before the @. If you use
- <systemitem><filename>mbox</filename></systemitem>
- or <systemitem><filename>mh</filename></systemitem>
- files as your mail source, you do not need to enter
- a username.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Authentication:</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Tell <application>Evolution</application> how to
- verify your identity with the server. Your options
- vary depending upon the type of server you are
- using, and the ways it is configured. Given the
- name of a server,
- <application>Evolution</application> can detect what
- sorts of authentication it offers.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Test Settings</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Click this button to have
- <application>Evolution</application> check to see if
- mail sources are configured correctly.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- <para>
- If you have several mail sources, clicking <guibutton>Get
- Mail</guibutton> will refresh any IMAP,
- <systemitem><filename>mh</filename></systemitem>, or
- <systemitem><filename>mbox</filename></systemitem>
- listings and check and download mail from all POP servers.
- In other words, <guibutton>Get Mail</guibutton> gets your
- mail, no matter how many sources you have, or what types
- they are.
- </para>
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3 id="config-prefs-mail-network-transports">
- <title>Mail Transports</title>
- <para>
- The <interface>Mail Transports</interface> tab lets you set
- how you will send mail. Evolution currently supports two
- mail transport options: <guilabel>SMTP</guilabel>, which
- uses a remote mail server, and
- <guilabel>sendmail</guilabel>, which uses the
- <application>sendmail</application> program on your local
- system. <application>Sendmail</application> is more
- difficult to configure, but offers more flexibility than
- <systemitem>SMTP</systemitem>.
- </para>
- <para>
- To use <guilabel>SMTP</guilabel>, you'll need to enter the
- name of your SMTP server. It may have the same name as
- your mail source server.
- </para>
- <para>
- <application>Evolution</application> can attempt to
- determine if you have entered a valid server name. To
- have it do so, click the <guilabel>Test
- Settings</guilabel> button.
- </para>
- </sect3>
- </sect2>
- <sect2 id="config-prefs-network-news">
- <title>News Servers</title>
- <para>
- Newsgroups are so much like mailing lists that there's no
- reason not to keep them right next to your mail. When you
- first select the <guilabel>News Servers</guilabel> tab,
- you will see a blank box with the three familiar buttons
- on the right: <guibutton>Add</guibutton>,
- <guibutton>Edit</guibutton>, and
- <guibutton>Delete</guibutton>.
- </para>
- <para>
- Click <guibutton>Add</guibutton> to add a news server; you
- will be prompted for its name. Enter the name, click
- <guibutton>OK</guibutton>, and you're done. You can have
- as many mail servers as you like, of course. News servers
- will appear next to your IMAP servers in the
- <interface>folder bar</interface>.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="config-prefs-mail-other">
- <title>Other Mail Preferences</title>
- <para>
- Not everything fits neatly into categories. This tab
- contains some miscellaneous configurations that don't have
- too much to do with each other.
- <variablelist>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term>
- <guilabel>Send messages in HTML format</guilabel>
- </term>
- <listitem><para>
- If you check this box, you will send
- messages as HTML by default. If you leave it unchecked, your
- messages will be sent without HTML formatting unless you select
- <menuchoice> <guimenu>Format</guimenu> <guimenuitem>HTML</guimenuitem>
- </menuchoice> in the message composer.
- See <xref linkend="usage-mail-getnsend-send-html">
- for more information about HTML mail.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term>
- <guilabel>Mark Messages as Seen After</guilabel>
- </term>
- <listitem><para>
- When you click on a message,
- <application>Evolution</application> will wait a
- moment before marking it as seen. You can set the
- delay, in milliseconds, here.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term>
- <guilabel>Folder Format</guilabel>
- </term>
- <listitem> <para> By default,
- <application>Evolution</application> saves its mail
- in the
- <systemitem><filename>mbox</filename></systemitem>
- format. You can switch to the
- <systemitem><filename>mh</filename></systemitem>
- format if you like. Note that this is an advanced
- feature and may cause you to lose some messages, so
- you should probably make a backup of your
- <systemitem><filename>evolution</filename></systemitem>
- directory first. In addition, it will take quite
- some time if you have a large mailbox.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="config-prefs-cal">
- <title>Configuring the Calendar</title>
- <para>
- To set your calendar preferences, select
- <menuchoice><guimenu>Settings</guimenu>
- <guimenuitem>Calendar
- Configuration</guimenuitem></menuchoice> from the Calendar
- view. This will open up the
- <interface>Preferences</interface> window. It contains four
- tabs: <guilabel>Time display</guilabel>,
- <guilabel>Colors</guilabel>, <guilabel>To Do List</guilabel>
- and <guilabel>Alarms</guilabel>. The <interface>calendar
- preferences window</interface> is illustrated in <xref
- linkend="config-prefs-cal-fig">.
-
- <!-- ==============Figure===================== -->
- <figure id="config-prefs-cal-fig">
- <title>Calendar Preferences Dialog</title>
- <screenshot>
- <screeninfo>If this worked on my job as well as my calendar...</screeninfo>
- <graphic fileref="fig/config-cal" format="png" srccredit="Aaron Weber">
- </graphic>
- </screenshot>
- </figure>
- <!-- ==============End of Figure================-->
- </para>
-
- <sect2 id="config-prefs-cal-time">
- <title>Time Display Settings</title>
- <para>
- The <guilabel>Time display</guilabel> tab lets you set the
- following:
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Time format</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>You may choose between twelve-hour (AM/PM) and
- twenty-four hour time formats here by clicking the
- appropriate radio button.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Weeks start on</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>You can set weeks to start on Sunday or on Monday.</para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Day range</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- When does your work day start, and when does it end?
- In the day and week views,
- <application>Evolution</application> displays all the
- hours in the range you select here, even if there are
- no appointments for those times. Of course, you can
- still schedule an appointment outside of these hours,
- and if you do, the display will be extended to show
- it.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
- <sect2 id="config-prefs-cal-color">
- <title>Calendar Colors</title>
- <para>
- The <interface>colors tab</interface> allows you to decide
- what color your calendar will be. The tab consists of a
- sample calendar on the right and a list of ten items that can
- be colored in different ways. If you click on the color
- button to the right of each item, you will bring up a
- color-selector window where you can choose to alter that
- color. By clicking <guibutton>OK</guibutton> in the color
- selection dialog, you can see the results of the color on the
- sample calendar.
- </para>
- <para>The display elements whose color you can set are:
-
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <guilabel>Outline:</guilabel> The lines between days
- and at the top of the display.
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem>
- <para> <guilabel>Headings:</guilabel> Text color for day
- and month names and other headings.
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem>
- <para> <guilabel>Empty days:</guilabel> This is the
- background color for any time slots in which you have no appointments.
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <guilabel>Appointments:</guilabel> This is the
- background color for any time slots in which you have appointments.
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem>
- <para> <guilabel>Highlighted day:</guilabel> The
- background color for a selected time slot.
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
-
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <guilabel>Day numbers:</guilabel> Text color for date numbers.
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
-
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <guilabel>Current day's number:</guilabel> Text color for today's date.
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem>
- <para> <guilabel>To-Do item that is not yet
- due:</guilabel> Text color for To-Do list items that are
- not yet due. (Or maybe background color? find out!)
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
-
- <listitem>
- <para> <guilabel>To-Do item that is due today:</guilabel>
- Text color for today's tasks.
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem>
- <para> <guilabel>To-Do item that is overdue:</guilabel>
- Text color for overdue tasks.
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- </itemizedlist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="config-prefs-cal-todo">
- <title>To Do List Settings</title>
- <para>
- You can choose what information the To Do list displays and the
- way it is displayed. The two areas of the <interface>To Do
- List</interface> tab offer several options each:
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Show on To Do List</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- This box contains three items. If you select the
- check boxes next to them, that information will appear
- in the To Do list for each task it contains:
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem>
- <para><guilabel>Due Date</guilabel></para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para><guilabel>Time Until Due</guilabel></para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para><guilabel>Priority</guilabel></para>
- </listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Style Options</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Select among the following checkboxes to determine
- how your To Do list will look:
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem>
- <para><guilabel>Highlight overdue items</guilabel></para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para><guilabel>Highlight items due today</guilabel></para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para><guilabel>Highlight not yet due items</guilabel></para>
- </listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="config-prefs-cal-alarms">
- <title>Alarms Settings</title>
- <para>
- The <interface>alarms tab</interface> enables you to select from three boxes:
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem>
- <para><guilabel>Beep on display alarms</guilabel>: select
- this box to have <application>Evolution</application> beep
- at you for any alarms you have set. If you leave this box
- unchecked, <application>Evolution</application> will only
- alert you to events by opening a dialog box. These beeps
- are distinct from full-fledged audio alarms.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para><guilabel>Audio alarms timeout after: </guilabel>
- Select this button to have your audio alarms stop
- automatically after a certain number of seconds. </para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para><guilabel>Enable snoozing for:</guilabel> If you
- would like to have the option to tell
- <application>Evolution</application> to repeat an alarm in
- a few minutes, select this button and decide how long
- you'd like it to wait.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="config-prefs-contact">
- <title>Managing the Contact Manager</title>
- <para>
- To set the behavior of your Contact Manager, click on the
- <guibutton>Contact Manager</guibutton> tab in the
- <interface>Preferences</interface> window.
- </para>
- <para>
- You can set the following options: <!--insert variable list
- here-->
- </para>
-
- <sect2 id="config-prefs-contact-ldap-add">
- <title>Adding Directory Servers</title>
- <para>
- To add a new LDAP server to your available contact
- folders, select <menuchoice> <guimenu>Actions</guimenu>
- <guimenuitem>New Directory Server</guimenuitem>
- </menuchoice>. This brings up a small dialog box which
- will let you enter the following options:
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem><para>
- <guilabel>Name</guilabel> &mdash; any name you choose for the server.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- <guilabel>Description</guilabel> &mdash; a longer description of the server.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- <guilabel>LDAP Server</guilabel> &mdash; the network address of the server.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- <guilabel>Port Number</guilabel> &mdash; by default, the port number is 389.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- <guilabel>Root DN</guilabel> &mdash; enter the root DN here.
- </para></listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
- </sect1>
-
-
-
- <sect1 id="config-prefs-general">
- <title>General Preferences</title>
- <para>
- Additional configuration options will be covered here, as
- they become available.
- </para>
- </sect1>
-</chapter>
-
-
-
-
-
-
diff --git a/doc/C/config-setupassist.sgml b/doc/C/config-setupassist.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index d9649f1adc..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/config-setupassist.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,214 +0,0 @@
- <chapter id="config-setupassist">
- <title>Easy Setup with the Setup Assistant</title>
- <para>
- The first time you try to use email, the mail setup assistant
- will ask you for some basic information, so
- <application>Evolution</application> can let you use email. If
- you prefer more detailed configuration, or if you want to make
- changes to an existing email setup, see <xref
- linkend="config-prefs">.
- </para>
-
- <sect1 id="config-setupassist-mail">
- <title>Mail Setup</title>
- <para>
- The first time you try to send or receive mail with
- <application>Evolution</application>, the <interface>mail
- setup assistant</interface> will pop up to help you with your
- email preferences. If you don't plan to use email, or if
- you'd rather deal with your email preferences later, click
- <guibutton>Cancel</guibutton>.
- </para>
-
-<!--
-
-
-
-Before you get it, though, you should decide where you want to
- keep it. Your options will vary a little depending on your
- network setup, but they come down to storing the mail on your
- hard disk (using <glossterm linkend="pop">POP</glossterm>), or
- storing it on the network (using <glossterm
- linkend="imap">IMAP</glossterm>). If you store your mail on
- your local hard disk, you can read it whether you're online or
- not, but you can only read it from one computer. If you store
- it on the network, you can only read it when you're online,
- but you can access it from almost any computer with a network
- connection, even if it doesn't have
- <application>Evolution</application>.
-
-
- If you choose POP, you'll be putting mail in the
- <guilabel>Inbox</guilabel> in the <guilabel>Local</guilabel>
- folder. If you choose IMAP, it's the
- <guilabel>Inbox</guilabel> of a folder with the same name as
- your mail server. That's so you can maintain several distinct
- IMAP servers if you want. See <xref
- linkend="config-prefs-mail"> for more information about mail
- servers.
--->
-
- <para>
- The setup assistant (sometimes called a
- <glossterm>Druid</glossterm>, by analogy with the "Wizards"
- that some other programs use) will guide you through the
- network configuration process. It will ask you for some
- basic information; your system administrator or ISP should
- have the answers you'll need. The mail setup assistant is
- pictured in <xref linkend="usage-setup-fig">.
-
-<!-- ==============Figure=================================== -->
-<!-- druid-pic should eventually become assistant-pic -->
-
- <figure id="usage-setup-fig">
- <title>Mail Setup Assistant</title>
- <screenshot>
- <screeninfo>Evolution Main Window</screeninfo>
- <graphic fileref="fig/mail-druid-pic" format="png" srccredit="Kevin Breit">
- </graphic>
- </screenshot>
- </figure>
-<!-- ==============End of Figure=================================== -->
-
-
-
- The assistant will ask you for the following information:
- <variablelist>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term> <guilabel>Name:</guilabel> </term> <listitem>
- <para>Your full name. </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Email address:</guilabel></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Your complete email address.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term> <guilabel>Organization:</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Any organization you represent, or the company where you
- work. Leave this blank if you wish, or type "My own bad
- self" so people know your opinions are yours alone.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Signature File:</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- A text file appended to any email you send. A signature
- file typically consists of your name and email address,
- or a quotation you like. It's good form to keep your
- "sig" on the short side: four lines is plenty. Remember,
- this is attached to every email you send.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term> <guilabel>Mail source type:</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <application>Evolution</application> supports several
- mail sources: <glossterm>POP</glossterm> and
- <glossterm>IMAP</glossterm> servers, and UNIX-style
- <systemitem><filename>mbox</filename></systemitem> and
- <systemitem><filename>mh</filename></systemitem> files.
- POP servers retrieve your mail and store it on your
- local system so you can refer to it even when not
- connected to a network; <glossterm>IMAP</glossterm>
- servers store the mail on the server so you can access
- it from multiple locations;
- <systemitem><filename>mbox</filename>></systemitem>
- files are used by your computer for internal mail, and
- may be useful if you want to switch from another email
- client such as <application>Spruce</application> or
- <application>Netscape Communicator</application>. Ask
- your system administrator which you should use, or keep
- guessing until one works. You may use multiple sources
- if you wish; see <xref
- linkend="config-prefs-mail-network"> for more
- information.
- </para>
- <para>
- If you decide not to have
- <application>Evolution</application> use any servers,
- the remaining items are not relevant; you only need to
- point to the location of the files you wish to access.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term> <guilabel>Server:</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- This should be the name of the server where you check
- your mail, if you use one. It may be the same as the
- server where you send your outgoing mail, if you use
- one.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Username:</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Enter the username for your mail server account, if you
- have one. Normally, this is the part of your email
- address before the @ character, and
- <application>Evolution</application> has selected that
- value as the default. If you have a different username,
- you can enter it here.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Authentication:</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Select the type of authentication you will use. You can
- click <guibutton>Detect supported types</guibutton> to
- find out which authentication protocols your network
- allows.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Mail Transport:</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- This is the mail sending protocol you will want to use.
- <application>Evolution</application> supports both SMTP
- and <application>sendmail</application>.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- <para>
- To learn how to configure <application>Evolution</application>
- in greater detail, or to change preferences once you have set
- them, see <xref linkend="config-prefs">.
- </para>
- </sect1>
-
-</chapter>
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
diff --git a/doc/C/config-sync.sgml b/doc/C/config-sync.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index 8fcf94e3af..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/config-sync.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,58 +0,0 @@
- <chapter id="config-sync">
- <title>Setting up your synchronization system</title>
- <para>
- Synchronization presents you with two issues you'll need to
- deal with. The first one is pretty simple: you'll need to get
- the data to move among the various devices you're using. If
- you've already got <application>Gnome-Pilot</application>
- working, then all you have to do is tell it to use the
- <application>Evolution</application>
- <glossterm>conduit</glossterm>. If you haven't used
- <application>Gnome-Pilot</application> before, you'll need to
- run the GNOME <application>Control Center</application> and go
- through the hand-held device setup assistant. Then you can
- select the Evolution conduit and press the hotsync button.
- </para>
- <para>
- If that doesn't work, jump up and down several times and swear
- loudly. Then make sure you've got
- <application>Gnome-Pilot</application> going to the right
- device (for my serial port, it's /dev/ttys0, not the default
- /dev/pilot) and that you have read and write permission on
- that device. If you don't, you'll need to be added to whatever
- group has those permissions (probably tty).
- </para>
- <para>
- Once <application>Evolution</application> knows how to get the
- mail, address, and calendar data, it needs to know what to do
- with it. When you synchronize your local data with the data
- on a server or handheld device, you may run into conflicts:
- perhaps you have ended up with two cards with the same name
- and different addresses, or old mail that has been deleted
- from one device but not the other. What if you want to keep
- only the a few contacts or messages on your hand-held or your
- laptop, but keep all the data server or your desktop machine?
- Select the <guibutton>Synchronization</guibutton> tab from the
- <interface>Preferences</interface> window to set up the
- conflict resolution preferences.
- </para>
- <para>
- You can set <application>Evolution</application>'s
- synchronization behavior in the following ways:
- <!-- LIST HERE -->
- </para>
- <para>
- <warning>
- <title>Data Loss Prevention</title>
- <para>
- It's always a good idea to make a backup. If you set your
- synchronization behaviors wrong, you could end up deleting
- the messages and cards you want to keep, and keeping the
- ones you want to delete. Before you change these
- preferences, make a backup of your the
- <systemitem><filename>evolution</filename></systemitem>
- directory.
- </para>
- </warning>
- </para>
- </chapter>
diff --git a/doc/C/evolution-guide.sgml b/doc/C/evolution-guide.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index 064bb0d305..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/evolution-guide.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,143 +0,0 @@
-<!DOCTYPE book PUBLIC "-//GNOME//DTD DocBook PNG Variant V1.1//EN"[
-
-<!ENTITY PREFACE SYSTEM "preface.sgml">
-<!ENTITY USAGE-MAINWINDOW SYSTEM "usage-mainwindow.sgml">
-<!ENTITY USAGE-MAIL SYSTEM "usage-mail.sgml">
-<!ENTITY USAGE-CONTACT SYSTEM "usage-contact.sgml">
-<!ENTITY USAGE-CALENDAR SYSTEM "usage-calendar.sgml">
-<!ENTITY USAGE-SYNC SYSTEM "usage-sync.sgml">
-<!ENTITY USAGE-PRINT SYSTEM "usage-print.sgml">
-<!ENTITY CONFIG-SETUPASSIST SYSTEM "config-setupassist.sgml">
-<!ENTITY CONFIG-PREFS SYSTEM "config-prefs.sgml">
-<!ENTITY CONFIG-SYNC SYSTEM "config-sync.sgml">
-<!ENTITY MENUREF SYSTEM "menuref.sgml">
-<!ENTITY APX-GLOSS SYSTEM "apx-gloss.sgml">
-<!ENTITY APX-BUGS SYSTEM "apx-bugs.sgml">
-<!ENTITY APX-AUTHORS SYSTEM "apx-authors.sgml">
-
-]>
-
-
-<!-- Almost every chapter is an entity. Files, Chapter id's, and
-entity names correspond. APX is for appendix. Note that there is no
-entity for apx-notes.sgml, which is still included in the file
-set. Reinstate the entity if and when the Notes feature is
-implemented. -->
-
-<book id="index">
- <bookinfo>
- <title>A User's Guide to Evolution</title>
- <authorgroup>
- <author><firstname>Aaron</firstname><surname>Weber</surname></author>
- <author><firstname>Kevin</firstname><surname>Breit</surname></author>
- </authorgroup>
- <copyright>
- <year>2000</year>
- <holder> Helix Code, Inc., </holder>
- <holder> Kevin Breit </holder>
- </copyright>
-
- <legalnotice id="legalnotice">
-
- <para>
- Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this
- document under the terms of the <ulink type="help"
- url="gnome-help:fdl"><citetitle>GNU Free Documentation
- License</citetitle></ulink>, Version 1.1 or any later version
- published by the Free Software Foundation with no Invariant
- Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. You
- may obtain a copy of the <citetitle>GNU Free Documentation
- License</citetitle> from the Free Software Foundation by
- visiting <ulink type="http" url="http://www.fsf.org">their
- Web site</ulink> or by writing to: Free Software Foundation,
- Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
- USA.
- </para>
- <para>
- Many of the names used by companies to distinguish their
- products and services are claimed as trademarks. Where those
- names appear in any GNOME documentation, and those trademarks
- are made aware to the members of the GNOME Documentation
- Project, the names have been printed in caps or initial caps.
- </para>
- </legalnotice>
-
- <releaseinfo>
- This is version 0.6 of the Evolution manual, describing version
- 0.6 of Evolution.
- </releaseinfo>
-
- </bookinfo>
-
- &PREFACE;
-
- <part id="usage">
- <title>Using Evolution</title>
- <partintro>
- <para>
- Part one of the <application>Evolution</application> manual
- describes how to use <application>Evolution</application>
- for email, contact management, and appointment and task
- scheduling. You'll find as you go along that, as with most of
- Linux, there's more than one way to do things, and you can
- pick whichever method you like best.
- </para>
- </partintro>
-
- &USAGE-MAINWINDOW;
- &USAGE-MAIL;
- &USAGE-CONTACT;
- &USAGE-CALENDAR;
-<!-- &USAGE-NOTES; -->
- &USAGE-SYNC;
- &USAGE-PRINT;
- </part>
- <part id="config">
- <title>Configuring and Managing Evolution</title>
- <partintro>
- <para>
- <application>Evolution</application> is highly configurable.
- Usually, when developers say that, they mean that they didn't
- test it out thoroughly and have left it to other programmers
- to "configure" themselves a working system. But in the case
- of <application>Evolution</application>, you can expect that
- it will work perfectly well with minimal setup hassle, and
- that you can alter its behavior to fit your needs with just a
- little more work. This part of the book will describe that
- process, from the quickest glimpse of the Setup Assistant to
- an in-depth tour of the preferences dialogs.
- </para>
- </partintro>
-
- &CONFIG-SETUPASSIST;
- &CONFIG-PREFS;
- &CONFIG-SYNC;
- </part>
-
- <part>
- <title>Comprehensive Menu reference</title>
- <partintro>
- <para>
- The following reference covers all, or nearly all, of the
- menus and menu commands that
- <application>Evolution</application> has to offer you.
- </para>
- </partintro>
- &MENUREF;
- </part>
-
- &APX-GLOSS;
- &APX-BUGS;
- &APX-AUTHORS;
-</book>
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
diff --git a/doc/C/fig/calendar.png b/doc/C/fig/calendar.png
deleted file mode 100644
index c9703f4903..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/fig/calendar.png
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/doc/C/fig/config-cal.png b/doc/C/fig/config-cal.png
deleted file mode 100644
index 25b5b68621..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/fig/config-cal.png
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/doc/C/fig/config-mail.png b/doc/C/fig/config-mail.png
deleted file mode 100644
index cd8543d94e..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/fig/config-mail.png
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/doc/C/fig/contact-editor.png b/doc/C/fig/contact-editor.png
deleted file mode 100644
index 988ad2f918..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/fig/contact-editor.png
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/doc/C/fig/contact.png b/doc/C/fig/contact.png
deleted file mode 100644
index a9ed02251a..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/fig/contact.png
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/doc/C/fig/filter-assist-fig.png b/doc/C/fig/filter-assist-fig.png
deleted file mode 100644
index 5248e0effe..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/fig/filter-assist-fig.png
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/doc/C/fig/filter-new-fig.png b/doc/C/fig/filter-new-fig.png
deleted file mode 100644
index a8b41ca678..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/fig/filter-new-fig.png
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/doc/C/fig/mail-composer.png b/doc/C/fig/mail-composer.png
deleted file mode 100644
index 22c16365b5..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/fig/mail-composer.png
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/doc/C/fig/mail-druid-pic.png b/doc/C/fig/mail-druid-pic.png
deleted file mode 100644
index f29f3e77be..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/fig/mail-druid-pic.png
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/doc/C/fig/mail-inbox.png b/doc/C/fig/mail-inbox.png
deleted file mode 100644
index b4f18640b4..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/fig/mail-inbox.png
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/doc/C/fig/mainwindow-pic.png b/doc/C/fig/mainwindow-pic.png
deleted file mode 100644
index 28bf487bf9..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/fig/mainwindow-pic.png
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/doc/C/fig/print-dest.png b/doc/C/fig/print-dest.png
deleted file mode 100644
index 464705711e..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/fig/print-dest.png
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/doc/C/fig/print-preview.png b/doc/C/fig/print-preview.png
deleted file mode 100644
index 7f9a8d661a..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/fig/print-preview.png
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/doc/C/fig/vfolder-createrule-fig.png b/doc/C/fig/vfolder-createrule-fig.png
deleted file mode 100644
index 162bebf48c..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/fig/vfolder-createrule-fig.png
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/doc/C/menuref.sgml b/doc/C/menuref.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index 036b663b23..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/menuref.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,1315 +0,0 @@
-<!--
-<!DOCTYPE Chapter PUBLIC "-//GNOME//DTD DocBook PNG Variant V1.1//EN">
--->
-
-<chapter id="menuref">
- <title>Menu Reference</title>
- <para>
- <application>Evolution</application>'s menus may not hold the
- secret to happiness, they do hold every ability that
- <application>Evolution</application> has. This section will serve
- as a reference for all those menus, and the capabilites that they
- offer you.
- </para>
- <para>
- In addition, the editor tools for messages, appointments, and
- contacts all have menu bars of their own. From left to right, the
- menus available to you when you are reading mail are:
- <guimenu>File</guimenu>, <guimenu>Edit</guimenu>,
- <guimenu>View</guimenu>, <guimenu>Settings</guimenu>,
- <guimenu>Message</guimenu>, <guimenu>Folder</guimenu>and
- <guimenu>Help</guimenu>.
-
- </para>
- <para>
- Menus in <application>Evolution</application> are
- context-sensitive, which means that they vary depending on what
- you're doing. If you're reading your mail, you'll have
- mail-related menus; for your calendar, you'll have
- calendar-related menu items. Some menus, of course, like
- <guimenu>Help</guimenu> and <guimenu>File</guimenu> don't much, if
- at all, because they have more universal functions. But you'd
- never mark an address card as "read," or set the recurrence for an
- email message you've recieved. depending on whether you're looking
- at mail, contacts, or calendar information.
- </para>
-
-
-
- <sect1 id="menuref-universal">
- <title>Menus that are the same everywhere</title>
- <para>
- The <guimenu>File</guimenu> and <guimenu>Help</guimenu> menus in
- the main <application>Evolution</application> window do not
- change, because they refer to universal items. Other menus have
- contents that change depending on context.
- </para>
-
- <sect2 id="menuref-universal-file">
- <title>File Menu</title>
- <para>
- <variablelist>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guisubmenu>New...</guisubmenu> Submenu</term>
- <listitem><para>
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem><para>
- <guimenuitem>Folder</guimenuitem> &mdash;
- Create a new folder. See <xref
- linkend="usage-mainwindow-folderbar">
- for more information about folders.
- </para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>
- <guimenuitem>Shortcut</guimenuitem> &mdash;
- Create a new Shortcut in the Shortcut Bar.
- </para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>
- <guimenuitem>Mail Message</guimenuitem> &mdash;
- Compose a new mail message. Covered in
- <xref linkend="usage-mail-getnsend-send">.
- </para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>
- <guimenuitem>Appointment</guimenuitem> &mdash;
- Enter a new appointment in your calendar. See <xref
- linkend="usage-calendar-apts-basic"> for more information.
- </para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>
- <guimenuitem>Task</guimenuitem> &mdash;
- Enter a new to-do item in your taskpad. Covered in
- <xref linkend="usage-calendar-todo">.
- </para></listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Go to Folder</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- View the items in a particular folder.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Create New Folder</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This item doesn't belong here any more.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Print Message</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Print the current message.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Exit</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Quit using <application>Evolution</application>.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="menuref-universal-help">
- <title>The Help Menu</title>
- <para>
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Help Index</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Displays the table of contents for this document.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Getting Started</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- A quick look around, and a summary of the things
- <application>Evolution</application> can do for you.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Using the Mailer</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- An in-depth tour of <application>Evolution</application> Mail.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Using the Calendar</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- A step-by-step guide to using the Calendar.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Using the Contact Manager</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Find your way around the Contact Manager.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Submit Bug Report</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- If you don't report them, they can't fix them. Select this item to let the
- developers know what's wrong.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>About Evolution</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Displays a window with information about the application and its authors.
- This has the same information as <xref linkend="authors">.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
- </sect1>
-
-
- <sect1 id="menuref-mail">
- <title>Mail Menus</title>
- <para>
- <application>Evolution</application> Mail has more specialized
- menus, and more specialized menu items, than any other part of
- the application.
- </para>
-
- <sect2 id="menuref-mail-edit">
- <title>The Edit Menu</title>
- <para>
- This menu is currently empty.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="menuref-mail-view">
- <title>The Mail View Menu</title>
- <para>
- This menu lets you control the way
- <application>Evolution</application> displays your information
- for you.
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Show Shortcut Bar</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Toggle the shortcut bar on and off with this item.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Show Folder Bar</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Toggle the folder bar on and off with this item.
- See <xref linkend="usage-mainwindow-folderbar"> for
- more information about the folder bar.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Threaded Message List</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This item controls whether your message list is displayed by thread
- or by other criteria. The default order is by date; see
- <xref linkend="usage-mail-listorder"> for information about the
- order of the message list.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="menuref-mail-tools">
- <title>The Mail Settings Menu</title>
- <para>
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Mail Filters</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Edit your mail filters here.
- See <xref linkend="usage-mail-organize-filters">
- for more information about mail filtering.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Virtual Folder Editor</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Create, edit, and delete Virtual Folders (<glossterm>vFolders</glossterm>)
- with this tool.
- To learn about using vFolders with mail, see
- <xref linkend="usage-mail-organize-vfolders">.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Mail Configuration</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Tools for setting up all your mail account preferences.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Manage Subscriptions</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Tools for newsgroup and IMAP folder subscriptions.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Forget Passwords</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This item will cause <application>Evolution</application>
- to forget what your password is.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="menuref-mail-folder">
- <title>The Mail Folder Menu</title>
- <para>
- The items in this menu relate to
- <application>Evolution</application> mail folders.
- </para>
- <para>
- You can:
- <variablelist>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Mark all as Read</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- <application>Evolution</application> keeps track of which messages
- you've seen; to mark everything in a folder as read, choose this item.
- You can mark a single message as read by right-clicking it in the message bar.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Delete All</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This is a favorite item of everyone with too much junk-mail: one click, and it
- deletes every message in the current folder.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Expunge</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Empties the trash folder, erasing messages permanently.
- Once you've done this, they're gone for good.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Configure Folder</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Use this item to set the file format in which
- <application>Evolution</application> stores mail. You
- can choose from standard UNIX-style
- <systemitem><filename>mbox</filename></systemitem>
- files, or the
- <systemitem><filename>mh</filename></systemitem> format.
- Converting large mailboxes may take a long time, and
- it's a good idea to have a backup copy beforehand.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="menuref-mail-message">
- <title>The Mail Message Menu</title>
- <para>
- The items in this menu relate to
- <application>Evolution</application> mail messages. Most of
- them require you to have a message selected, and are also
- available by right-clicking on a message in the message
- list.
- </para>
- <para>
- <variablelist>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Open in New Window</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Displays the selected message in a new window.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Edit Message</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Open the selected message in the message composer. You
- can only edit a message you have written: drafts and messages in
- the <guilabel>Sent</guilabel> box.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Print Message</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Displays the <interface>Print Preview</interface> window,
- ready for printing.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Reply to Sender</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Opens a message composition window addressed to the
- author of the message. Covered in detail in
- <xref linkend="usage-mail-getnsend-send-reply">.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Reply to All</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Opens a message composition window addressed to the
- author of the message and all known recipients.
- Covered in detail in <xref linkend="usage-mail-getnsend-send-reply">.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Forward</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Appends the body of the selected message to a new message.
- Covered in detail in <xref linkend="usage-mail-getnsend-fwd">.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Delete Message</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Marks a message for deletion.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Move Message</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Choose a folder in which to place this message.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Copy Message</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Copy the selected message to another folder.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>VFolder on Subject</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This item, and the three that follow it, will create vFolders
- which you may customize further or save as-is. This one will
- create a vFolder which will display all messages that contain the
- subject line of the selected message.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>VFolder on Sender</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Creates a vFolder to hold all messages from the sender of
- the selected message.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>VFolder on Recipients</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Creates a VFolder to hold all messages addressed to the
- recipient of the selected message.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Filter on Subject</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This item, and the three that follow it, will create Filters
- for which you must select actions. You may keep the criteria as
- they are, or alter them as you wish. This one will
- create a filter which will affect all messages that contain the
- subject line of the selected message.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Filter on Sender</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Creates a filter which affects all messages from the sender of
- the selected message.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Filter on Recipients</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Creates a filter which will affect all messages addressed to the
- recipient of the selected message.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="menuref-mail-editor">
- <title>The Message Composer Menus</title>
- <para>
- The message composition window has its own set of menus:
- <guimenu>File</guimenu>, which controls operations on files and
- data, <guimenu>Edit</guimenu>, for text editing,
- <guimenu>Format</guimenu>, which controls the file format of
- messages you send, <guimenu>View</guimenu>, to set how you view
- the message, and <guimenu>Insert</guimenu>, which holds tools
- for embedding files and other items in messages. Here's what's in them:
- </para>
- <sect2 id="menuref-mail-editor-file">
- <title>The Message Composer's File Menu</title>
- <para>
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenu>Open</guimenu></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Open a text file or a draft mail message.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenu>Save</guimenu></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Save a mail message as a text file.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenu>Save As</guimenu></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Choose a file name and location for
- a message you want to save as a text file.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenu>Save in Folder</guimenu></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Save a message as a draft, rather than
- as a separate text file.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenu>Insert Text File</guimenu></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Open a text file and insert it into
- the current message. (FIXME: belongs under "Insert").
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenu>Send Now</guimenu></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Sends the message immediately.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenu>Send Later</guimenu></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Queue
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenu>Close</guimenu></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Closes the message composer. If you have not done so,
- <application>Evolution</application>
- will ask you if you want to save your message.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
- <sect2 id="menuref-mail-editor-edit">
- <title>The Message Composer's Edit Menu</title>
- <para>
- The <guimenu>Edit</guimenu> menu in the message composer
- contains the following items. Keyboard shortcuts are listed
- next to the items in the menus themselves.
-
- <variablelist>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Undo</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Undoes the last action you performed.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Redo</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- If you change your mind about Undoing something,
- you can always use this item.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Cut</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Removes the selected text from the text entry window and
- retains it in the system "clipboard" memory, ready for pasting.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Copy</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Copies selected text to the system clipboard without deleting it.
- The text can then be inserted elsewhere with the
- <guimenuitem>Paste</guimenuitem> command.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Paste</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Inserts the contents of the system clipboard at the
- location of the cursor.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Find</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Enter a phrase and find your match in your message body.
- As with <guimenuitem>Find Regex</guimenuitem>,
- <guimenuitem>Find Again</guimenuitem>, and
- <guimenuitem>Replace</guimenuitem>, <application>Evolution</application>
- will offer you the option to search forwards or backwards.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Find Regex</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- If you are familiar with <glossterm>regular expressions</glossterm>,
- often called "regexes," you can search for something more complicated,
- using wildcards and boolean logic.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Find Again</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Repeats your last search.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Replace</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Enter a word or phrase and the word or phrase with which you'd like
- to replace it.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Properties</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This item brings up the Message Composer Properties Capplet,
- a portion of the GNOME Control Center that determines the
- key bindings for the message composer. Help for this capplet is
- available directly from the Control Center.
- (FIXME: Write that help doc too) (FIXME: this is in the wrong place!)
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
- <sect2 id="menuref-mail-composer-format">
- <title>The Message Composer's Format Menu</title>
- <para>
- The <guimenu>Format</guimenu> menu has only one item:
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>HTML</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Toggles HTML mode for the message composer. When selected,
- the message is displayed and sent in HTML. If you have written a
- message in HTML and turn HTML off, most formatting will be lost.
- <application>Evolution</application> will attempt to preserve spacing
- and to remove formatting gracefully, however.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
- <sect2 id="menuref-mail-composer-view">
- <title>The Message Composer's View Menu</title>
- <para>
- The <guimenu>View</guimenu> menu controls the way messages are
- displayed, and how much of the message, its headers, and
- attachments appear. It contains:
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Show Attachments</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Toggles the display of attachments. When this item is selected,
- <application>Evolution</application> will create a separate pane
- of the composition window to show what attachments you are appending
- to the message.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
- <sect2 id="menuref-mail-composer-insert">
- <title>The Message Composer's Insert Menu</title>
- <para>
- The <guimenu>Insert</guimenu> menu holds tools that allow you
- to include images, horizontal rules, and other objects
- in the body of your message. The tools are:
- <variablelist>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Image</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This tool will prompt you to select an image file to
- insert into your HTML message. For text messages, this
- is the same as attaching an image file.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Link</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Opens the <interface>link creation window</interface>,
- which lets you specify the URL and text description
- for a link in your message. This only works with HTML
- messages.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Rule</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Opens the<interface> horizontal rule creation dialog</interface>, which lets you
- create an HTML horizontal rule. For more information,
- see <xref linkend="usage-mail-getnsend-send-html">.
- This tool only works with HTML messages.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Text File</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Open a text file and insert it into the current message.
- This tool works with both plain text and HTML messages.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="menuref-cal">
- <title>The Calendar Menus</title>
- <para>
- The Main window of the calendar has the same menus as the main
- window of the mail client. However, their contents vary in a
- number of ways.
- </para>
- <sect2 id="menuref-cal-edit">
- <title>The Calendar Edit Menu</title>
- <para>
- The contents of the Edit menu are currently so borked that I
- refuse to document them right now. (That means FIXME). They
- should be:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Item</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Description
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Item</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Description
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Item</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Description
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
- <sect2 id="menuref-cal-view">
- <title>The Calendar View Menu</title>
- <para>
- The Calendar's <guimenu>View</guimenu> menu contains the following items:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Show Shortcut Bar</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Toggle the Shortcut Bar on and off with this item.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Show Folder Bar</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Toggle the folder bar on and off with this item.
- See <xref linkend="usage-mainwindow-folderbar"> for
- more information about the folder bar.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>View By Day</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Switch to the day view for your calendar.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>View Five Days</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- View five calendar days at once.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>View by Week</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Switch the calendar view to full week mode.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>View By Month</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Look at a month at a time.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="menuref-cal-settings">
- <title>The Calendar Settings Menu</title>
- <para>
- This menu is empty.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="menuref-cal-editor">
- <title>The Appointment Editor Menus</title>
- <para>
- The appointment editor has its own menus, to help you use its
- wide-ranging abilities.
- </para>
-
- <sect2 id="menuref-cal-editor-file">
- <title>The Appointment Editor's File Menu</title>
- <para>
- This menu contains several items, including a <guisubmenu>New</guisubmenu> submenu
- that is identical to that in the
- <link linkend="menuref-universal-file">main window's file menu</link>.
- Its other contents are:
- <variablelist>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Send</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Opens a mail message with the appointment attached to it.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Save</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Save this appointment in the existing location and name. If you have not yet
- chosen a location and name, this is the same as <guimenuitem>Save As</guimenuitem>.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Save As</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Choose a location and name for this appointment, and save it.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Delete</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Deletes the appointment.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Move to Folder</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Chose a folder, and move the appointment into it.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Copy to Folder</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Chose a folder, and put a copy of the appointment into it.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Page Setup Submenu</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This menu contains two items:
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem><para>
- <guimenuitem>Memo Style</guimenuitem> &mdash;
- FIXME: What does this do?
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- <guimenuitem>Define Print Styles</guimenuitem> &mdash;
- FIXME: What does this do?
- </para></listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Print Preview</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para> Shows you what your appointment will look
- like if you print it. See <xref linkend="usage-print">
- for details on printing and the Print Preview function.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Print</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Prints the appointment without preview.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Properties</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- FIXME: What does this do?
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Close</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Close the appointment editor window.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="menuref-cal-editor-edit">
- <title>The Appointment Editor's Edit Menu</title>
- <para>
- FIXME: this menu is copied and pasted entirely from somewhere
- else.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="menuref-cal-editor-view">
- <title>The Appointment Editor's View Menu</title>
- <para>
- This menu allows you to look at different appointments, and
- set the way you look at them, without having to move back to
- the <interface>Main Window</interface>. It contains:
- <variablelist>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guisubmenu>Previous</guisubmenu></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The items in this submenu will take you to appointments
- prior to the current one. (FIXME: describe).
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guisubmenu>Next</guisubmenu></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The items in this submenu will take you to appointments
- scheduled to occur after the current one. (FIXME: describe).
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Calendar</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- FIXME: What does this item do?
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guisubmenu>Toolbars</guisubmenu></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The <guisubmenu>Toolbars</guisubmenu> submenu
- allows you to choose which toolbars
- are displayed in the
- <interface>Appointment Editor</interface>. They are:
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem><para>
- <guimenuitem>Standard</guimenuitem> &mdash;
- Toggle the standard toolbar on and off.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- <guimenuitem>Formatting</guimenuitem> &mdash;
- Toggle the formatting toolbar on and off.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- <guimenuitem>Customize</guimenuitem> &mdash;
- Select the contents of the formatting and standard toolbars.
- </para></listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="menuref-cal-editor-insert">
- <title>The Appointment Editor's Insert Menu</title>
- <para>
- This menu contains: (FIXME: Insert Content Here)
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>File</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Choose a file to append to your appointment or appointment request.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Item</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- FIXME: ?
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Object</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- FIXME: ?
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="menuref-cal-editor-format">
- <title>The Appointment Editor's Format Menu</title>
- <para>
- This menu contains two items, neither of which
- have any functionality yet:
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Font</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- FIXME: ?
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Paragraph</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- FIXME: ?
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="menuref-cal-editor-tools">
- <title>The Appointment Editor's Tools Menu</title>
- <para>
- This menu contains four items, including the
- <guisubmenu>Forms</guisubmenu> submenu, which allows you to
- alter calendar forms and create your own entries. None of
- this works yet, though.
-
- <variablelist>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Spelling</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Checks the spelling of your calendar entry.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Check Names</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para> Checks the names listed here against
- those in your address book.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Address Book</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- FIXME: ?
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guisubmenu>Forms</guisubmenu> Submenu</term>
- <listitem><para>
- The Forms submenu lets you alter the
- appearance of Calendar Forms.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
-
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="menuref-cal-editor-actions">
- <title>The Appointment Editor's Actions Menu</title>
- <para>
- This menu contains:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Schedule Meeting</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Brings up the <interface>Meeting Invitation</interface> window,
- described in <xref linkend="usage-calendar-apts">.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Cancel Invitation</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Cancels the event, notifying all attendees. You may be prompted
- to specify an invitation message.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Forward as vCalendar</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Opens the message composer with the current event attached.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Forward as Text</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Opens the message composer with a text description of the current
- event included in the message body.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="menuref-cal-editor-help">
- <title>The Appointment Editor's File Menu</title>
- <para>
- This menu is empty.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1>
- <title>Contact Manager Menus</title>
- <para>
- The contact manager has six menus: <guimenu>File</guimenu>,
- <guimenu>Edit</guimenu>, <guimenu>View</guimenu>,
- <guimenu>Setting</guimenu>s, <guimenu>Tools</guimenu>, and
- <guimenu>Help</guimenu>.
- </para>
-
- <sect2 id="menuref-contact-edit">
- <title>Contact Manager Edit Menu</title>
- <para>
- This menu is empty.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
-
- <sect2 id="menuref-contact-view">
- <title>Contact Manager View Menu</title>
- <para>
- This menu contains the following items:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Show Shortcut Bar</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Toggle the Shortcut Bar on and off with this item.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Show Folder Bar</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Toggle the folder bar on and off with this item.
- See <xref linkend="usage-mainwindow-folderbar"> for
- more information about the folder bar.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>As Table</guimenuitem> / <guimenuitem>As Minicards</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- View your contacts as a table.
- When in table-view mode, this menu item reads
- <guimenuitem>As Minicards</guimenuitem>, and changes the view
- back to the minicard format.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="menuref-contact-tools">
- <title>Contact Manager Tools Menu</title>
- <para>
- This menu contains one item:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Search for
- Contacts</guimenuitem></term> <listitem><para> Brings up
- the in-depth search window. <xref
- linkend="contact-search"> describes how to use this
- feature. </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
-
-
- <sect2 id="menuref-contact-actions">
- <title>Contact Manager Tools Menu</title>
- <para>
- This menu contains only one item:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>New Directory Server</guimenuitem></term> <listitem><para> Brings up
- the in-depth search window. <xref
- linkend="config-prefs-contact-ldap-add"> describes how to use this
- feature. </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
-
- </para>
- </sect2>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="menuref-contact-editor">
- <title>The Contact Editor Menus</title>
- <para>
- This window has only one menu: the file menu.
- </para>
-
- <sect2 id="menuref-contact-editor-file">
- <title>Contact Editor File Menu</title>
- <para>
- This menu contains five items:
- <variablelist>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Save</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
-
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Save As</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Allows you to save the contact as an external
- file in the <glossterm linkend="vcard">VCard</glossterm> format.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Print</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Prints the current contact.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Delete</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Deletes the current contact.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Close</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Closes the Contact Editor without saving.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
- </sect1>
-
-
-</chapter>
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
diff --git a/doc/C/preface.sgml b/doc/C/preface.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index 2987dd7988..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/preface.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,427 +0,0 @@
-<!--
-<!DOCTYPE preface PUBLIC "-//GNOME//DTD DocBook PNG Variant V1.1//EN">
--->
-
- <preface id="introduction">
-<!-- =============Introduction ============================= -->
- <title>Introduction</title>
-
- <sect1 id="what">
- <title>What is Evolution, and What Can It Do for Me?</title>
- <para>
- Information is useless unless it's organized and accessible;
- it's hardly even worth the name if you can't look at it and be
- <emphasis>informed</emphasis>.
- <application>Evolution</application>'s goal is to make the
- tasks of storing, organizing, and retrieving information
- easier, so you can work and communicate with others. That is,
- it's a highly evolved <glossterm
- linkend="groupware">groupware</glossterm> program, an integral
- part of the Internet-connected desktop. On the inside, it's a
- powerful database; on the outside, it's a tool to help you get
- your work done.
- </para>
- <para>
- Because it's part of the GNOME project,
- <application>Evolution</application> is free software. The
- program and its source code are released under the terms of
- the <ulink type="help" url="gnome-help:gpl"><citetitle>GNU
- Public License (GPL)</citetitle></ulink>, and the
- documentation falls under the <ulink type="help"
- url="gnome-help:fdl"><citetitle>Free Documentation
- License</citetitle></ulink> (FDL). For more information about
- the GPL and the FDL, visit the Free Software Foundation's
- website at <ulink
- url="http://www.fsf.org">http://www.fsf.org</ulink>.
- </para>
- <para>
- <note>
- <title>This is a preview release</title>
- <para>
- <application>Evolution</application> is not complete, and
- still has a lot of flaws. Please help improve it by
- letting us know about them. You should do this by
- submitting bug reports with the GNOME <application>Bug
- Report Tool</application> (known as
- <command>bug-buddy</command> at the command line).
- </para>
- </note>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- <application>Evolution</application> can help you work in a
- group, by handling email, address and other contact
- information, and one or more calendars. It can do that on one
- or several computers, connected directly or over a network,
- for one person or for large groups.
- <application>Evolution</application> can handle almost all
- your communications and information management tasks with the
- power and flexibility of the GNOME desktop environment.
- </para>
- <para>
- The <application>Evolution</application> project has four
- central goals:
-
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- The application must be <emphasis>both powerful and easy
- to use</emphasis>. That means a familiar and intuitive
- interface that users can customize to their liking, and
- the development of shortcuts for complex tasks.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <application>Evolution</application> must meet and
- exceed the standards set by other groupware products.
- It must include support for major network <glossterm
- linkend="protocol">protocols</glossterm> so that it can
- integrate seamlessly with existing hardware and network
- environments.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- The project must support open standards and be open to
- expansion, so that it can become a development platform
- as well as an application. From the simplest scripting
- to the most complex network and component programming,
- <application>Evolution</application> must offer
- developers an environment for cutting-edge application
- development.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Data must be safe: <application>Evolution</application>
- must not lose mail, corrupt mailbox files or other
- data, execute arbitrary <glossterm linkend="script">scripts</glossterm>,
- or delete files from your hard disk.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </para>
- <para>
- <application>Evolution</application> is designed to make most
- daily tasks faster. For example, it takes only one or two
- clicks to enter an appointment or an address card sent to you
- by email, or to send email to a contact or appointment.
- <application>Evolution</application> makes displays faster and
- more efficient, so searches are faster and memory usage is
- lower. People who get lots of mail will appreciate advanced
- features like <link
- linkend="usage-mail-organize-vFolders">vFolders</link>, which
- let you save searches as though they were ordinary mail
- folders.
- </para>
-
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="aboutbook">
- <title>About This Book</title>
- <!-- ************** FOLLOWING PARAGRAPH FOR DRAFT ONLY ************* -->
- <para>
- This version of the <application>Evolution</application>
- User's Guide is a <emphasis>draft</emphasis>. It describes
- version 0.6 of the software. It is missing huge
- chunks of information, and many of the features it describes
- are unimplemented. All the content is subject to change,
- especially if you help. Please send comments on the guide to
- <email>aaron@helixcode.com</email>. If you would like to work
- on the guide please contact me or see the GNOME Documentation
- project <ulink
- url="http://developer.gnome.org/projects/gdp">web
- site</ulink>. This paragraph will be removed in later
- versions of the manual.
- </para>
- <!-- ************* END DRAFT ONLY PARAGRAPH ************** -->
-
- <para>
- This book is divided into two parts, with several
- appendices. The first part is a <link linkend="usage">guided
- tour</link>&mdash; it will explain how to use
- <application>Evolution</application>. If you are new to
- <application>Evolution</application> or to groupware in
- general, this is the section for you. The second section,
- covering <link linkend="config">configuration</link>, is
- targeted at more advanced users, but anyone who wants to
- change the way <application>Evolution</application> looks or
- acts can benefit from reading it. In addition, there is a
- comprehensive <link linkend="menuref">menu
- reference</link> which describes nearly every capability that
- <application>Evolution</application> has to offer.
- </para>
- <formalpara>
- <title>Typographical conventions</title>
- <para>
- Some kinds of words are marked off with special typography:
- <simplelist>
- <member><application>Applications</application></member>
- <member><command>Commands</command> typed at the command line</member>
- <member><guilabel>Labels</guilabel> for interface items</member>
-
- <member> Menu selections look like this:
- <menuchoice>
- <guimenu>Menu</guimenu>
- <guisubmenu>Submenu</guisubmenu>
- <guimenuitem>Menu Item</guimenuitem>
- </menuchoice>
- </member>
- <member><guibutton>Buttons</guibutton> you can
- click</member> <member><userinput>Anything you type
- in</userinput></member> <member><computeroutput>Text
- output from a computer</computeroutput></member>
- <member><glossterm linkend="apx-gloss">Words</glossterm>
- that are defined in the <xref linkend="apx-gloss">.</member>
- </simplelist>
- </para>
- </formalpara>
- </sect1>
- <sect1 id="commontasks">
- <title>Quick Reference for Common Tasks</title>
- <para>
- You might want to get a copy of this section and tape it to
- the wall next to your computer: it's a very short summary of
- most of the things you'll want to do with
- <application>Evolution</application>, and pointers to the
- sections of the book where you'll find more in-depth
- description of those tasks.
- </para>
- <sect2 id="quickref-newthings">
- <title>Opening or Creating Anything</title>
- <para>
- Here are the keyboard shortcuts and menu items you're most
- likely to use: (Please note that the shortcuts listed are
- probably wrong at this point).
-
- <variablelist>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Create a new folder</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <menuchoice><guimenu>File</guimenu><guisubmenu>New</guisubmenu>
- <guimenuitem>Folder</guimenuitem></menuchoice> or
- <keycombo action="simul">
- <keycap>Ctrl</keycap>
- <keycap>Shift </keycap>
- <keycap>F</keycap>
- </keycombo>
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Create a new Shortcut in the Evolution Bar</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <menuchoice><guimenu>File</guimenu>
- <guisubmenu>New</guisubmenu>
- <guimenuitem>Evolution Bar Shortcut</guimenuitem> </menuchoice> or
- <keycombo action="simul">
- <keycap>Ctrl</keycap>
- <keycap>Shift</keycap>
- <keycap>S</keycap>
- </keycombo>
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Create a new email message:</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Use
- <menuchoice><guimenu>File</guimenu><guisubmenu>New</guisubmenu><guimenuitem>Mail
- Message</guimenuitem> </menuchoice> or
- <keycombo action="simul">
- <keycap>Ctrl</keycap>
- <keycap>Shift </keycap>
- <keycap>M</keycap>
- </keycombo>
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Create a new Appointment</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <menuchoice><guimenu>File</guimenu>
- <guisubmenu>New</guisubmenu>
- <guimenuitem>Appointment</guimenuitem> </menuchoice> or
- <keycombo action="simul">
- <keycap>Ctrl</keycap>
- <keycap>Shift</keycap>
- <keycap>A</keycap>
- </keycombo>
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Create a new Task</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <menuchoice><guimenu>File</guimenu>
- <guisubmenu>New</guisubmenu>
- <guimenuitem>Task</guimenuitem> </menuchoice> or
- <keycombo action="simul">
- <keycap>Ctrl</keycap>
- <keycap>Shift</keycap>
- <keycap>T</keycap>
- </keycombo>
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Enter a new Contact</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <menuchoice><guimenu>File</guimenu>
- <guisubmenu>New</guisubmenu>
- <guimenuitem>Contact</guimenuitem> </menuchoice> or
- <keycombo action="simul">
- <keycap>Ctrl</keycap>
- <keycap>Shift</keycap>
- <keycap>C</keycap>
- </keycombo>
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </sect2>
- <sect2 id="quickref-mail">
- <title>Mail Tasks</title>
- <para>
- Here are the most frequent email tasks, and shortcuts for navigating your mailbox with the keyboard instead of the mouse:
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Check Mail</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Click <guibutton>Get Mail</guibutton> in the toolbar, or press
- <keycombo action="simul">
- <keycap>FIXME</keycap>
- <keycap>FIXME</keycap>
- <keycap>FIXME</keycap>
- </keycombo>
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Reply to a Message</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Select the message to which you want to reply, and
- click <guibutton>Reply</guibutton> in the
- toolbar, or press
- <keycombo action="simul">
- <keycap>FIXME</keycap>
- <keycap>FIXME</keycap>
- <keycap>FIXME</keycap>
- </keycombo>
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Forward a Message</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Select the message you want to forward, and
- click <guibutton>Forward</guibutton> in the
- toolbar, or press
- <keycombo action="simul">
- <keycap>FIXME</keycap>
- <keycap>FIXME</keycap>
- <keycap>FIXME</keycap>
- </keycombo>
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Open a Message in a New Window</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Double-click the message you want to view, or press
- <keycombo action="simul">
- <keycap>Ctrl</keycap>
- <keycap>O</keycap>
- </keycombo>
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Create Filters and vFolders</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- You can create filters and vFolders based on specific
- message attributes by right-clicking on a message or
- by selecting <menuchoice> <guimenu>Tools</guimenu>
- <guimenuitem>Mail Filters</guimenuitem> </menuchoice>
- or <menuchoice> <guimenu>Tools</guimenu>
- <guimenuitem>vFolder Editor</guimenuitem>
- </menuchoice>. Filters are discussed in <xref
- linkend="usage-mail-organize-filters">, and vFolders
- in <xref linkend="usage-mail-organize-vfolders">.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
-
- </para>
- </sect2>
- <sect2 id="quickref-cal">
- <title>Calendar</title>
- <para>
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
-
- </para>
- </sect2>
- <sect2 id="quickref-contact">
- <title>Contact Manager</title>
- <para>
-
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
-
-
- </para>
- </sect2>
- </sect1>
- </preface>
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
diff --git a/doc/C/usage-calendar.sgml b/doc/C/usage-calendar.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index 72f278a424..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/usage-calendar.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,367 +0,0 @@
-<!--
-<!DOCTYPE Chapter PUBLIC "-//GNOME//DTD DocBook PNG Variant V1.1//EN">
--->
-
-<chapter id="usage-calendar">
- <title>The Evolution Calendar</title>
- <para>
- To begin using the calendar, select
- <guibutton>Calendar</guibutton> from the <interface>shortcut
- bar</interface>. By default, the calendar starts showing today's
- schedule on a grey and white ruled background. At the upper
- right, there's a monthly calendar you can use to switch days.
- Below that, there's a <guilabel>TaskPad</guilabel>, where you can
- keep a sort of glorified to-do list that's not linked to your
- calendar. The calendar's daily view is shown in <xref
- linkend="usage-calendar-fig">.
-
- <!-- ============== Figure ============================= -->
- <figure id="usage-calendar-fig">
- <title>Evolution Calendar View</title>
- <screenshot>
- <screeninfo>Evolution Contact Manager Window</screeninfo>
- <graphic fileref="fig/calendar" format="png" srccredit="Aaron Weber">
- </graphic>
- </screenshot>
- </figure>
- <!-- ============== End of Figure ============================= -->
-
- </para>
- <sect1 id ="usage-calendar-view">
- <title>Ways of Looking at your Calendar</title>
-
- <para>
- You can view your calendar by the day, by the week, by the
- month, or by the year; press the calendar-shaped buttons on the
- right side of the toolbar to switch between views.
- </para>
- <para>
- To view yesterday's appointments, &mdash;last week's, if you're in
- the weekly view, and last month's for the monthly view&mdash; click
- the <guibutton>Prev</guibutton> button. For tomorrow, next week,
- or next month, click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>, and of course,
- click <guibutton>Today</guibutton> for today.
- </para>
- <para>
- To visit a specific date's calendar entries, click
- <guibutton>Go To</guibutton> and select the date in the dialog
- box that appears.
- </para>
-
-
-<!-- ############### FIXME FIXME FIXME ############
-Feature not yet implemented, and may not be implemented due to
-lack of time, resources, and interest.
- <para>
- In addition, <application>Evolution</application> supports
- Hebrew, Muslim, and other calendar formats. To switch to a
- different calendar format, choose
- <guimenuitem>GUIMENUITEM</guimenuitem> from the
- <guimenu>GUIMENU</guimenu>.
- </para>
-################ END FIXME AREA ################## -->
-
- </sect1>
- <sect1 id="usage-calendar-apts">
- <title>Scheduling With the Evolution Calendar</title>
- <para>
- The <application>Evolution</application> calendar allows you to
- schedule events for yourself or a group of people. It can
- handle events that repeat, event lengths from ten minutes to
- multiple days, and events that have a date but no specific
- time. Of course, you can also set event reminders and alarms
- so that you don't forget about everything you've just put into
- your calendar. From office or family to office
- <emphasis>and</emphasis> family,
- <application>Evolution</application> can handle the schedule.
- </para>
- <sect2 id="usage-calendar-apts-basic">
- <title>Creating events</title>
- <para>
- To create a new calendar event, select
- <menuchoice>
- <guimenu>File</guimenu>
- <guisubmenu>New</guisubmenu>
- <guimenuitem>Appointment</guimenuitem>
- </menuchoice>
- or click the <guibutton>New</guibutton> button on the left end
- of the toolbar. The <interface>New Appointment</interface>
- dialog will pop up with the usual menu bar, tool bar, and
- window full of choices for you.
- </para>
- <tip id="new-appointment-shortcut">
- <title>Shortcut</title>
- <para>
- If you don't need to enter more information than the date
- and time of the appointment, you just click in any blank
- space in the calendar and start typing. You can enter other
- information later with the appointment editor.
- </para>
- </tip>
-
- <para>
- Your event must have a starting and ending date &mdash; by
- default, today &mdash; but you can choose whether to give it
- starting and ending times or to mark it as an <guilabel>All
- day event</guilabel>. An <guilabel>All day event</guilabel>
- appears at the top of a day's event list rather than inside
- it. That makes it easy to have events that overlap and fit
- inside each other. For example, a conference might be an all
- day event, and the meetings at the conference would be timed
- events. Of course, events with specific starting and ending
- times can also overlap. When they do they're displayed as
- multiple columns in the day view of the calendar.
- </para>
- <note>
- <title>Doing Two Things At Once</title>
- <para>
- If you create calendar events that overlap,
- <application>Evolution</application> will display them side
- by side in your calendar. However,
- <application>Evolution</application> cannot help you do
- multiple things at once.
- </para>
- </note>
- <para>
- You can have as many as four different
- <guilabel>Alarms</guilabel>, any time prior to the event
- you've scheduled. You can have one alarm of each type:
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Display</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- A window will pop up on your screen to remind you of
- your event.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Audio</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Choose this to have your computer deliver a sound
- alarm.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Program</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Select this if you would like some additional application
- to run as a reminder. You can enter its name in the
- text field, or find it with the
- <guibutton>Browse</guibutton> button.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Mail</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <application>Evolution</application> will send an
- email reminder to the address you enter into the text
- field.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
-
- </para>
- <para>
- <guilabel>Classification</guilabel> is a little more
- complicated, and only applies to calendars on a
- network. <guilabel>Public</guilabel> is the default category,
- and a public event can be viewed by anyone on the calendar
- sharing network. <guilabel>Private</guilabel> denotes one
- level of security, and <guilabel>Confidential</guilabel> a
- higher level. <!-- FIXME --> Exact determinations and implementations of
- this feature have yet to be determined. <!-- FIXME -->
- </para>
- <para>
- The <guilabel>Recurrence</guilabel> tab lets you describe
- repetition in events ranging from once every day up to once
- every 100 years. You can then choose a time when repetition
- will stop, and, under <guilabel>Exceptions</guilabel>, pick
- individual days when the event will <emphasis>not</emphasis>
- recur.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Once you're done with all those settings, click on the disk
- icon in the toolbar. That will save the event and close the
- event editor window. If you want, you can alter an event
- summary in the calendar view by clicking on it and typing. You
- can change other settings by right-clicking on the event in
- the and then choosing <guimenuitem>Edit this Appointment</guimenuitem>.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
-<!-- ############UNIMPLEMENTED FEATURES ###################
-
- <sect2 id="usage-calendar-apts-group">
- <title>Appointments for Groups</title>
- <para>
- If you have your calendar set up to work with other
- calendars over a network, you can see when others are
- available to meet with you.
- </para>
- <note>
- <title>Unimplemented Feature</title>
- <para>This feature is not yet implemented.</para>
- </note>
-
- <para>
- In addition, you can use <application>Evolution</application>
- to mark a meeting request on another person's calendar. To do
- it, click <guibutton>New</guibutton> in the calendar toolbar,
- or select <menuchoice> <guimenu>File</guimenu>
- <guisubmenu>New</guisubmenu>
- <guimenuitem>Appointment</guimenuitem> </menuchoice> to bring
- up the <interface>new event</interface> window. Then describe
- the event as you would any other. Before you click
- <guibutton>OK</guibutton>, (INSERT DESCRIPTION HERE...).
- <application>Evolution</application> will automatically send
- email to each person on the request list, notifying of the
- time and date of the meeting you have requested with them. In
- addition, it will mark the event on your calendar and on
- theirs as tentative, rather than a confirmed, event.
- </para>
- <para>
- To mark a tentative event as confirmed, click once on the
- event in the <interface>calendar view</interface> to select
- it, and then choose <guimenuitem>Event
- Properties</guimenuitem> from the <guimenu>Settings</guimenu>
- menu. In the <interface>Event Properties</interface> dialog
- window, click the "tentative" button to De-select the
- event.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
-
- <sect2 id="usage-calendar-apts-privs">
- <title>Scheduling privileges</title>
- <para>
- There are several levels of scheduling privileges. You
- can set whether people can see your calendar, whether they
- can request meetings or appointments, and whether they can
- create appointments. This section may have to be deleted,
- because I don't know if we are going to support privileges
- at all.
- </para>
- </sect2>
- ########## END UNIMPLEMENTED FEATURESET ############ -->
-
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="usage-calendar-todo">
- <title>The Task Pad</title>
- <para>
- The Task Pad, located in the lower right corner of the
- calendar, lets you keep a list of tasks separate from your
- calendar events. Tasks are colored and sorted by priority and
- due-date (see <xref linkend="config-prefs"> for more
- information), and are included with calendar data during
- synchronization with a hand-held device.
- </para>
- <para>
- To record a new task, click the <guibutton>Add</guibutton>
- button below the list. <application>Evolution</application>
- will pop up a small window with five items in it:
-
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term> <guilabel>Summary:</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- The description you enter here will appear in the To Do
- list itself.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term> <guilabel>Due Date:</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Decide when this item is
- due. You can either type in a date and time, or select one from
- the <guibutton>Calendar</guibutton> and time drop-down menus.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Priority:</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Select a level of importance from 1 (most important) to 9
- (least important).
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term> <guilabel>Item Comments:</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- If you wish, you can keep a more detailed description of
- the item here.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- <para>
- Once you've added a task to your to-do list, its summary
- appears in the <guilabel>Summary</guilabel> section of the
- calendar window. To view or edit a detailed description of an
- item, double-click on it, or select it and click
- <guibutton>Edit</guibutton>. You can delete items by selecting
- them and clicking on the <guibutton>Delete</guibutton> button.
- </para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="usage-calendar-multiple">
- <title>Multiple Calendars</title>
- <para>
- <application>Evolution</application> permits you to have and
- maintain multiple calendars. This is useful if you maintain
- schedules for other people, if you are responsible for resource
- or room allocation, or if you have multiple personalities.
- </para>
-
- <example>
- <title>Keeping Multiple Calendars</title>
- <para>
- Keelyn. the office manager for a small company, has one
- calendar for her own schedule. On the local network, she
- maintains one for the conference room, so people know when
- they can schedule meetings. Next to that, she maintains a
- calendar that reflects when consultants are going to be on
- site, and another that keeps track of when the Red Sox are
- playing.
- </para>
- </example>
- <para>
- To create a new calendar, select
- <menuchoice>
- <guimenu>File</guimenu> <guisubmenu>New</guisubmenu>
- <guimenuitem>Calendar</guimenuitem>
- </menuchoice>.
- You can place the calendar in any calendar folder and access it
- from the folder view. Alarms, configuration, and display for
- each calendar are separate from each other.
- </para>
-
- </sect1>
-</chapter>
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
diff --git a/doc/C/usage-contact.sgml b/doc/C/usage-contact.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index 21630cacb3..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/usage-contact.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,617 +0,0 @@
-<!--
-<!DOCTYPE Chapter PUBLIC "-//GNOME//DTD DocBook PNG Variant V1.1//EN">
--->
-
-<chapter id="usage-contact">
- <title>The Evolution Contact Manager</title>
- <abstract>
- <para>
- The <application>Evolution</application> contact manager can
- handle all of the functions of an address book, phone book, or
- Rolodex. Of course, it's a lot easier to update
- <application>Evolution</application> than it is to change an
- actual paper book. <application>Evolution</application> also
- allows easy synchronization with hand-held and remote devices.
- Since <application>Evolution</application> supports most major
- network protocols, including <glossterm linkend="ldap">LDAP</glossterm>, it can
- fit into almost any existing network.
- </para>
- <para>
- Another advantage of the <application>Evolution</application>
- address book is its integration with the rest of the
- application. That means that when you look for someone's
- address, you can also see a history of appointments with that
- person. Or, you can get an e-mail with contact information in
- it and create a new address card on the spot. In addition,
- searches and folders and all work in the same way they do in the
- other components, so you don't have to learn another system for
- similar tasks.
- </para>
- <para>
- This chapter will cover using the
- <application>Evolution</application> contact manager to organize
- any amount of contact information, share addresses over a
- network, and several ways to save time with everyday tasks. To
- learn about configuring the contact manager, see <xref
- linkend="config-prefs-contact">.
- </para>
- </abstract>
- <sect1 id="usage-contact-basic">
- <title>Getting Started With the Contact Manager</title>
-
- <para>
- To open up your address book, click on
- <guibutton>Contacts</guibutton> in the shortcut bar, or select
- one of your contacts folders from the folder bar. <xref
- linkend="usage-contact-fig"> shows the Contact Manager in all
- its organizational glory. By default, the contact manager
- shows all your cards in alphabetical order, in a <glossterm
- linkend="minicard">minicard</glossterm> format. You can select
- other views from the <guimenu>View</guimenu> menu, and adjust
- the width of the columns by clicking and dragging the grey
- column dividers.
- </para>
-
-
- <figure id="usage-contact-fig">
- <title>Evolution Contact Manager</title>
- <screenshot>
- <screeninfo>Evolution Contact Manager Window</screeninfo>
- <graphic fileref="fig/contact" format="png" srccredit="Aaron Weber">
- </graphic>
- </screenshot>
- </figure>
-
- <para>
- The toolbar for the address book is quite simple:
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem><para>
- Press <guibutton>New</guibutton> for a new contact.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- <guibutton>Find</guibutton> brings up an in-depth search window.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- Press <guibutton>Print</guibutton> to print one or more cards.
- </para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>
- <guibutton>Delete</guibutton> deletes a selected card.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para> <guibutton>View All</guibutton> Displays all
- the address information in the folder. Use this button to
- refresh the display for a network folder, or to switch from
- viewing the results of a search and see the whole contents.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para> <guibutton>Stop</guibutton> Stop loading
- contact data from the network. This button is only
- relevant if you are looking at contact information on a
- network. </para></listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The rest of the contact manager is taken up by the display of
- your contact information. You can view that display as a table
- or as a list of cards&mdash; switch views in the
- <guimenu>View</guimenu> menu &mdash; and move through them
- alphabetically with the buttons and the scrollbar at the right
- of the window. Of course, if you have more than a few people
- listed, you'll want some way of finding them more quickly,
- which is why there's a search feature.
- </para>
-
- <sect2 id="contact-search">
- <title>Searching for Contacts</title>
- <para>
- Between <guilabel>Delete</guilabel> and <guilabel>View
- All</guilabel> is <guilabel>Quick Search</guilabel>. To use
- it, just type in one or more words you're looking for and
- hit <keycap>Enter</keycap>.
- <application>Evolution</application> will search through
- the contents of every displayed card to find one that
- matches. That means that you can refine searches by doing several in
- succession.
- </para>
- <para>
- If there are no matches, the card display will be blank. When
- you'd like to see all the cards again, press <guilabel>Show
- All</guilabel>.
- </para>
- <example id="contact-quicksearch-ex">
- <title>Refining a Quick Search</title>
- <para>
- Tom comes back from lunch and finds a note on his keyboard:
- "Curtis in sales called for you, but he didn't leave a number,
- and I forgot to write down the name of the company he works
- for. He said it was important, though." Tom is not at all
- annoyed.
- </para>
- <para>
- He opens his contacts folder, and runs a quick search for
- "Curtis;" there are eighteen different people with that name
- in the file. He then enters "Sales," and
- <application>Evolution</application> narrows it down to the
- right Curtis. He only becomes annoyed when he discovers that
- the call was not actually important.
- </para>
- </example>
-
- <para>
- If you prefer to perform a more complex search, press
- <guibutton>Find</guibutton> or choose
- <menuchoice><guimenu>Tools</guimenu><guimenuitem>Search for
- Contact</guimenuitem></menuchoice>. This will open the in-depth search window, which
- lets you use multiple search criteria in the same way that
- email filters and <glossterm linkend="vfolder">vFolders</glossterm> do..
- </para>
- <para>
- Click <guibutton>Add Criterion</guibutton> to increase the
- number of criteria you'd like to use in the search, and
- <guibutton>Remove Criterion</guibutton> to remove one from the
- bottom of the list. Your criteria may be a searchs within the
- <guilabel>Name</guilabel> or <guilabel>Email</guilabel>
- fields; alternately you can choose to search through all the
- fields with a regular expression. Then, you can select all
- the familiar requirements like <guilabel>Begins
- With</guilabel> and <guilabel>Does Not Contain</guilabel>,
- decide whether to match <guilabel>All</guilabel> or
- <guilabel>Any</guilabel> of your criteria, and press
- <guibutton>Search</guibutton> to set it all off.
- </para>
-
- </sect2>
-
- </sect1>
- <sect1 id="usage-contact-cards">
- <title>Destroy, Create, and Change: The Contact Editor</title>
- <para>
- To delete a card, click on it once to select it, then press the
- <guibutton>Delete Card</guibutton> button. If you have
- multiple cards selected, you'll delete multiple cards.
- </para>
- <para>
- Adding or changing cards is slightly more complicated. Any
- time you add information to the contact manager, whether it's
- an old card you're editing or a new card you're just adding to
- your address book, you'll use the contact editor. To change a
- card that already exists, just double click it to open the
- contact editor window with all the current information already
- filled in. If you want to create a new one, clicking the
- <guibutton>New Card</guibutton> button will open up that same
- window, but with empty fields instead of full ones. Either
- way, it's the same tool for quite similar tasks, and you'll
- find that it's pretty flexible and can store quite a lot more
- than you'd think would fit onto a file card.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The contact editor window has two tabs,
- <guilabel>General</guilabel>, for basic contact information,
- and <guilabel>Details</guilabel>, for a more specific
- description of the person. In addition, it contains a
- <guimenu>File</guimenu> menu, covered in <xref
- linkend="menuref-contact-editor">, and a toolbar with three
- items: <guilabel>Save and Close</guilabel>,
- <guilabel>Print</guilabel>, and <guilabel>Delete</guilabel>.
- After that, however, it gets slightly more complicated, as you
- can see in <xref linkend="usage-contact-editor-fig">.
- </para>
-
- <figure id="usage-contact-editor-fig">
- <title>Evolution Contact Editor</title>
- <screenshot>
- <screeninfo>Evolution Contact Editor</screeninfo>
- <graphic fileref="fig/contact-editor" format="png" srccredit="Aaron Weber">
- </graphic>
- </screenshot>
- </figure>
-
- <para> The <guilabel>General</guilabel> tab contains no less
- than seven sections, each with an icon: a face, for name and
- company; a telephone for phone numbers; an envelope for email
- address; a globe for web page address; a house for postal
- address; a file folder for contacts, and a briefcase for
- categories. You can guess what sort of information belongs in
- fields like <guilabel>Job Title</guilabel> and <guilabel>Web
- page address</guilabel>, but there are several parts of the
- window that are a little more interesting.
- </para>
- <para>
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Full Name</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- The <guilabel>Full Name</guilabel> field has two
- major features:
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- You can enter a name into the <guibutton>Full
- Name</guibutton> field, but you can also click the
- <guibutton>Full Name</guibutton> button to bring
- up a small dialog box with a few text boxes
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Title: </guilabel></term>
- <listitem> <para>
- Enter an honorific or select one from the menu.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>First: </guilabel></term>
- <listitem> <para>
- The person's first, or given, name.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Middle: </guilabel></term>
- <listitem> <para>
- The middle name or initial, if any, goes here.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Last: </guilabel></term>
- <listitem> <para>
- The last name (surname) belongs here.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Suffix: </guilabel></term>
- <listitem> <para>
- Suffixes such as "Jr." or "III" can go here.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- The <guilabel>Full Name</guilabel> field also
- interacts with the <guilabel>File As</guilabel>
- box to help you organize your contacts.
- </para>
- <para>
- To see how it works, type a name in the
- <guilabel>Full Name</guilabel> field:
- <userinput>Eva Lucianne Tester</userinput>.
- You'll notice that the <guilabel>File
- As</guilabel> field also fills up, but in reverse:
- <computeroutput>Tester, Eva</computeroutput>.
- You can pick <computeroutput>Eva
- Tester</computeroutput> from the drop-down, or
- type in your own, such as <userinput>Lucianne
- Tester, Eva</userinput>.
- </para>
- <tip>
- <title>Filing Suggestion</title>
-
- <para>
- Don't enter something entirely different from
- the actual name, since you might forget that
- you've filed Eva's information under "F" for
- "Fictitious Helix Code Employee."
- </para>
- </tip>
- </listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Multiple Values for Fields</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- If you click on the small arrow buttons next to the
- <guilabel>Primary Email</guilabel> field, you can also
- choose <guilabel>Email 2</guilabel> and
- <guilabel>Email 3</guilabel>. Although the contact
- editor will only display one of those at any given
- time, <application>Evolution</application> will
- remember them all. The arrow buttons next to the
- telephone and postal address fields work in the same
- way.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- <para>
- The last item in the <guilabel>General</guilabel> tab is the
- <guilabel>Categories</guilabel> organization tool. That's
- really its own topic; for information on that, read <xref
- linkend="usage-contact-organize">.
- </para>
- <para>
- The <guilabel>Details</guilabel> tab is, fortunately, much more
- simple: three sections, all of which are more or less obvious:
- the briefcase next to the details about the contact's
- professional life; the face next to the details about their
- personal life; the globe next to a big blank space you can use
- for anything and everything else you'd like to note about them.
- If you ever wanted to have that uncanny knack for remembering
- obscure details like the date of someone's anniversary (perhaps
- your own) this is the answer.
- </para>
-
-
-
-
-<!--- ############# This section isn't implemented yet either:
- <sect2>
- <title></title>
- <para>
- <tip>
- <title>Contact Shortcuts</title>
- <para>
- You can add cards from within an email message or calendar
- appointment. While looking at an email, right-click on
- any email address or message, and choose
- <guimenuitem>Create Card for this Address</guimenuitem> or
- <guimenuitem>Create Card for this Sender</guimenuitem>
- from the menu. While looking at a calendar appointment,
- right-click any email address, and choose
- <guimenuitem>Create Card for this Address</guimenuitem>.
- (NOTE that feature may change! unimplemented!)
- </para>
- </tip>
- </para>
- <para>
- You can move cards around just as you would move email
- messages: dragging and dropping works, as does right-clicking
- and choosing <guimenuitem>Move</guimenuitem> from the menu
- that appears.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-############### SHORTCUT SECTION COMMENTED OUT FOR NOW -->
-
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="usage-contact-organize">
- <title>Organizing your Contact Manager</title>
- <para>
- Organizing your contact manager is a lot like organizing your
- mail. You can have folders and searches the same way you can
- with mail, but the contact manager does not allow vFolders. It
- does, however, allow each card to fall under several
- categories, and allow you to create your own categories. To
- learn about categories, read <xref
- linkend="usage-contact-organize-group-category">.
- </para>
-
-<!--
- <para>
- Another useful <application>Evolution</application> feature is
- its ability to recognize when people live or work together. If
- several people in your contact manager share an address, and you
- change the address for one of them,
- <application>Evolution</application> will ask you if you wish to
- change the address for all of them, or just for one.
- </para>
--->
-
- <sect2 id="usage-contact-organize-group">
- <title>Groups of contacts</title>
- <para>
- <application>Evolution</application> offers two ways for you
- to organize your cards. The first way is to use folders;
- this works the same way that mail folders do. For more
- flexibility, you can also mark contacts as members of
- different categories.
- </para>
-
- <sect3 id="usage-contact-organize-group-folder">
- <title>Grouping with Folders</title>
- <para>
- The simplest way to group address cards is to use folders.
- By default, cards start in the
- <guilabel>Contacts</guilabel> folder. If you've read <xref
- linkend="usage-mainwindow"> then you already know that you
- can create a new folder by selecting
- <menuchoice>
- <guimenu>File</guimenu>
- <guisubmenu>New</guisubmenu>
- <guimenuitem>Folder</guimenuitem>
- </menuchoice>
- and that you can put new folders anywhere you like. Just
- like with mail, cards must be in a card folder, and no card
- can be in two places at once. If you want more
- flexibility, try <xref
- linkend="usage-contact-organize-group-category">.
- </para>
- <para>
- To put a card into a folder, just drag it there from the
- folder view. Remember that contact cards can only go in
- contact folders, just like mail can only go in mail folders,
- and calendars in calendar folders.
- </para>
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3 id="usage-contact-organize-group-category">
- <title>Grouping with Categories</title>
- <para>
- The other way to group cards is to mark them as belonging
- to different categories. The difference between folders
- and categories is that folders contain cards, but category
- membership is a property of each card. That means that you
- can mark a card as being in several categories or no
- category at all. For example, I put my friend Matthew's
- card in the "Business" category, because he works with me,
- the "Friends" category, because he's also my friend, and
- the "Frequent" category, because I call him all the time
- and can never remember his phone number.
- </para>
- <para>
- To mark a card as belonging to a category, click the
- <guibutton>Categories</guibutton> button at the lower
- right. From the dialog box that appears, you can check as
- many or as few categories as you like.
- </para>
- <para>
- Then, you can refer to all the cards in that category by:
- <!-- FIXME --> Waiting for Evolution to support the
- operation.
- </para>
-
- <!-- FIXME: Feature Not Implemented
- <para>
-
- If the master list of categories doesn't suit you, you can
- add your own. Just enter the new category's name in the
- text box, then click <guibutton>Categories</guibutton> and
- choose <guilabel>Add to Master List</guilabel> in the
- window that appears.
- </para>
- -->
-
- </sect3>
- </sect2>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="usage-contact-sharing">
- <title>Sharing your Cards</title>
- <para>
- If you keep your cards on a network using an
- <glossterm linkend="ldap">LDAP</glossterm> server, you can share access to
- them. Actually, the server software takes care of that, and
- also determines who is allowed to see and change them. This is
- the sort of feature you'll want to use if your company has a
- list of vendors and clients that needs constant updating. If
- you also share your calendars, people can avoid duplicating
- work and keep up to date on developments within their work-group
- or across the entire company.
- </para>
-
- <example id="usage-contact-sharing-ex">
- <title>Sharing Address Cards and Calendar Data</title>
- <para>
- Ray wants to schedule a meeting with Company X, so he
- checks the network for the Company X address card so he
- knows whom to call there. Since his company also shares
- calendars, he then learns that his co-worker Deanna has
- already scheduled a meeting with Company X next Thursday.
- He can either go to the meeting himself or ask Deanna to
- discuss his concerns for him. Either way, he avoids
- scheduling an extra meeting with Company X.
- </para>
- </example>
- <para>
- Of course, you don't want to share all of your cards&mdash; why
- overload the network with a list of babysitters, or tell
- everyone in the office you're talking to new job prospects? If
- you keep cards on your own computer, you can decide which items
- you want to make accessible to others.
- </para>
- <para>
- To learn how to add a remote directory to your available
- contact folders, see <xref linkend="config-prefs-contact">.
- Once you have a connection, the network contacts folder or
- folders will appear inside the <guilabel>External
- Directories</guilabel> folder in the folder bar, and will work
- exactly like a local folder of cards, with the following
- exceptions:
- <itemizedlist>
-
- <listitem><para>
- They are only available when you are connected to the network. If
- you use a laptop or have a modem connection, you may wish to copy or cache
- the network directory and then synchronize your copy with the networked version
- periodically.
- </para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>
- To prevent excess network traffic,
- <application>Evolution</application> will not normally
- load the contents of LDAP folders immediately upon
- opening. You must click <guilabel>Display
- All</guilabel> before LDAP folder cards will be loaded
- from the network. You can change this behavior in the
- <interface>Contact Preferences</interface> window.
- </para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>
- Your ability to view, change, add or delete
- contacts depends on the settings of the LDAP server.
- For example, you may read all the entries in the public
- Netcenter directory (available by default in the
- <guilabel>External Directories</guilabel> folder), but
- you may not change or delete any of them.
- </para></listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="usage-contact-automate">
- <title>Contact Manager Tools</title>
- <para>
- The contact manager works with
- <application>Evolution</application> mail and the calendar to
- help you add new address cards quickly. However, it can also
- manage mailing lists. There are more tools planned, and when
- they arrive, <!-- FIXME --> they will be described in this
- section.
- </para>
-
- <sect2 id="contact-automation-basic">
- <title>Send me a Card: Adding New Cards Quickly</title>
- <para>
- As noted before, when you get information about a person in
- the mail or in a calendar entry, you can add it to an address
- card. To do so, right click on any email address or email
- message, and select <guimenuitem>Add Address
- Card</guimenuitem> from the menu that appears. Of course,
- <application> Evolution</application> also adds cards from a
- hand-held device during HotSync operation. For more
- information about that, see <xref linkend="usage-sync">.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="contact-automation-lists">
- <title>Managing a Mailing list</title>
- <para>
- You already know that when you are writing an email, you can
- address it to one or more people, and that
- <application>Evolution</application> will fill in addresses
- from your contact manager's address cards if you let it. In
- addition to that, you can send email to everyone in a
- particular group.
- </para>
- <!-- FIXME this feature not yet implemented -->
- <para>
- Future versions of <application>Evolution</application> will
- allow you to you export a group of cards to a spreadsheet,
- database, or word processor so you can print address labels
- or prepare large postal mailings.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-<!--
- <sect2 id="usage-contact-automation-extra">
- <title>Map It!</title>
- <para>
- Need a map or directions? Click
- <guibutton>MapIt</guibutton> from within the contact
- manager, and <application>Evolution</application> will
- map the address for you online.
- </para>
- </sect2>
--->
-
- </sect1>
-
-</chapter>
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
diff --git a/doc/C/usage-mail.sgml b/doc/C/usage-mail.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index 6aafdaa492..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/usage-mail.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,1382 +0,0 @@
-<!--
-<!DOCTYPE Chapter PUBLIC "-//GNOME//DTD DocBook PNG Variant V1.1//EN">
--->
-
-<chapter id="usage-mail">
- <title>Evolution Mail</title>
- <abstract>
- <title> An Overview of the Evolution Mailer</title>
- <para>
- <application>Evolution</application> email is like other email
- programs in all the ways you would hope:
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- It can sort and organize your mail in a wide variety of ways with
- folders, searches, and filters.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- It can send and receive mail in HTML or as plain text, and
- supports file attachments.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- It supports multiple mail sources, including <glossterm
- linkend="imap">IMAP</glossterm>, <glossterm
- linkend="pop">POP3</glossterm>, local
- <systemitem><filename>mbox</filename></systemitem> and
- <systemitem><filename>mh</filename></systemitem> files, and
- even NNTP messages (newsgroups), which aren't technically
- email.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </para>
- <para>
- However, <application>Evolution</application> has some important
- differences. First, it's built to handle very large amounts of
- mail without slowing down or crashing. Both the <link
- linkend="usage-mail-organize-filters">filtering</link> and <link
- linkend="usage-mail-organize-search">searching</link> functions
- were built for speed and efficiency on gargantuan mail
- volumes. There's also the <application>Evolution</application>
- <link linkend="usage-mail-organize-vFolders">vFolder</link>, an
- advanced organizational feature not found in other mail clients.
- If you get a lot of mail, or if you keep every message you get
- in case you need to refer to it later, you'll find that feature
- especially useful.
- </para>
- </abstract>
-
- <sect1 id="usage-mail-getnsend">
- <title>Reading, Getting and Sending Mail</title>
-
- <sect2 id="usage-mail-getnsend-read">
- <title>Reading Mail</title>
- <para>
- You can start reading email by clicking
- <guibutton>Inbox</guibutton> in the shortcut bar. By
- default, the <interface>Inbox</interface> is open when you
- start <application>Evolution</application>, and the first
- time you see your Inbox, there's a message in it from Helix
- Code welcoming you to the application.
- </para>
- <para>
- The <application>Evolution</application>
- <guilabel>Inbox</guilabel>, should look like the one in <xref
- linkend="usage-mail-intro-fig">, which has a message from
- Helix Code. The message summary appears at the top, in the
- <interface>message list</interface>. The message itself is
- displayed below that, in the <interface>view pane</interface>.
- If you find the <interface>view pane</interface> too small,
- you can double-click on the message in the <interface>message
- list</interface> to have it open in a new window. Just like
- with folders, you can right-click on messages in the message
- list and get a menu of possible actions.
- </para>
-
- <!-- ==============Figure=================================== -->
-
- <figure id="usage-mail-intro-fig">
- <title>Evolution Mail</title>
- <screenshot>
- <screeninfo>Inbox</screeninfo>
- <graphic fileref="fig/mail-pic" format="png" srccredit="Aaron Weber">
- </graphic>
- </screenshot>
- </figure>
-<!-- ==============End of Figure============================== -->
-
- <para>
- Most of the mail-related actions you'll want to perform are
- listed in the <guimenu>Message</guimenu> menu in the menu
- bar. The most frequently used ones, like
- <guimenuitem>Reply</guimenuitem> and
- <guimenuitem>Forward</guimenuitem>, also appear as buttons in
- the toolbar, and almost all of them are duplicated in the
- right-click menu and as keyboard shortcuts, which tend to be
- faster once you get the hang of them. You can choose
- whichever way you like best; the idea is that the software
- should work the way you want, rather than making you work the
- way the it does.
- </para>
-
- <sect3 id="usage-mail-listorder">
- <title>Sorting the message list</title>
- <para>
- One of the ways <application>Evolution</application> lets
- you choose the way you work is the way it lets you sort your
- message lists. To sort by sender, subject, or date, click
- on the bars with those labels at the top of the message
- list. If you click twice, you'll sort them in reverse
- order.
- </para>
- <para>
- You can also choose a threaded message view. Select
- <menuchoice> <guimenu>View</guimenu>
- <guimenuitem>Threaded</guimenuitem> </menuchoice> to turn
- the threaded view on or off. If the option selected,
- <application>Evolution</application> will attempt to
- associate related messages by using message ID numbers and
- the <systemitem>References</systemitem>,
- <systemitem>In-Reply-To</systemitem>, and
- <systemitem>Subject</systemitem> message headers. Messages
- which are related are then placed next to each other, so
- that it's easier to follow the thread of a conversation from
- message to message.
- </para>
- </sect3>
- <sect3 id="usage-mail-getnsend-delete">
- <title>Deleting Mail</title>
- <para>
- Once you've read your mail, you may want to get rid of
- it. To mark a message for deletion, select it in the the
- <interface>message list</interface> by clicking on it once.
- Then click on the <guibutton>Delete</guibutton> button in
- the tool bar. The message now has a line through it,
- because you've marked it for deletion.
- </para>
- <para>
- If you really want to get rid of it, choose
- <guimenuitem>Expunge</guimenuitem> from the
- <guimenu>Folder</guimenu> menu. That will delete it
- permanently. If you want to keep it, click
- <guibutton>Delete</guibutton> again, and it will no longer
- be marked as deleted. At some point in the future, this
- feature will change to something a little less
- counter-intuitive.
- </para>
- </sect3>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="usage-mail-getnsend-get">
- <title>Checking Mail</title>
- <para>
- Now that you've had a look around the
- <interface>Inbox</interface>, it's time to check for new mail.
- Click <guibutton>Get mail</guibutton> in the toolbar to check
- your mail. If it's the first time you've done so, the
- <interface>mail setup assistant</interface> will ask you for
- the information it needs to check your mail (see <xref
- linkend="config-setupassist"> for more information).
- </para>
- <para>
- Then, you need to enter your email
- password. <application>Evolution</application> will remember
- the password until you quit the application or until you
- select <menuchoice> <guimenu>Settings</guimenu>
- <guimenuitem>Forget Passwords</guimenuitem> </menuchoice>.
- </para>
- <para>
- Once it's validated the password,
- <application>Evolution</application> will check your mail.
- New mail will appear in the local <interface>Inbox</interface>
- if you're using a <glossterm>POP</glossterm> account, and in
- your <glossterm>IMAP</glossterm> folders if you use IMAP.
- </para>
-
- <note id="badmailsettings">
- <title>Can't Check Mail?</title>
- <para>
- If you get an error message instead of mail, you probably need
- to change your network settings. To learn how to do that,
- have a look at <xref linkend="config-prefs-mail-network">, or
- ask your system administrator.
- </para>
- </note>
-
- <sect3 id="usage-mail-getnsend-get-news">
- <title>Using Evolution for News </title>
- <para>
- Newsgroups are so similar to email there's no reason not to
- read them side by side. If you want to do that, add a news
- source to your configuration (see <xref
- linkend="config-prefs-network-news">). The news server will
- appear as a remote server, and will look quite similar to an
- IMAP folder. When you click <guibutton>Get Mail</guibutton>,
- <application>Evolution</application> will also check for news
- messages.
- </para>
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3 id="usage-mail-getnsend-get-attach">
- <title>Attachments and HTML Mail</title>
- <para>
- If someone sends you an <glossterm>attachment</glossterm>, a
- file attached to an email,
- <application>Evolution</application> will display the file
- at the bottom of the message to which it's attached. Text,
- HTML, and most images will be displayed within the message
- itself. For other files,
- <application>Evolution</application> will provide a link and
- icon at the end of the message. Click on that, and
- <application>Evolution</application> will ask you where you
- want to put the file. Once you've chosen a location and
- saved the file, you can open, move, copy, or execute it just
- like any other, using <application>Nautilus</application> or
- your favorite shell or file manager.
- </para>
- <para>
- As usual, there's a shortcut here: right-click on the link,
- and choose an application for the file: you can send an
- image straight to the <application>GIMP</application>, or a
- spredsheet straight to <application>Gnumeric</application>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- <application>Evolution</application> can also display
- HTML-formatted mail, complete with graphics. HTML
- formatting will display automatically, although you can
- turn it off if you prefer.
- </para>
- </sect3>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="usage-mail-getnsend-send">
- <title>Writing and Sending Mail</title>
- <para>
- You can start writing a new email message by selecting
- <menuchoice> <guimenu>File</guimenu>
- <guisubmenu>New</guisubmenu> <guimenuitem>
- Mail</guimenuitem></menuchoice>, or by pressing the
- <guibutton>Compose</guibutton> button in the Inbox toolbar.
- When you do so, the <interface>New Message</interface> window
- will open, as shown in <xref
- linkend="usage-mail-newmsg-fig">.
- </para>
-
-<!-- ==============Figure=================================== -->
- <figure id="usage-mail-newmsg-fig">
- <title>New Message Window</title>
- <screenshot>
- <screeninfo>Evolution Main Window</screeninfo>
- <graphic fileref="fig/newmsg-pic" format="png" srccredit="Kevin Breit">
- </graphic>
- </screenshot>
- </figure>
-<!-- ==============End of Figure=================================== -->
-
- <!-- Check the alignment of the following paragraph in the PS and
- HTML output: it's indented for no good reason -->
- <para>
- Enter an address in the <guilabel>To:</guilabel> field, a
- subject in the <guilabel>Subject:</guilabel> and a message in
- the big empty box at the bottom of the window, and press
- <guibutton>Send</guibutton>. That's easy, although it can
- get a little more complicated if you want.
- </para>
-
- <sect3 id="usage-mail-getnsend-send-delay">
- <title>Saving Messages for Later</title>
- <para>
- Evolution will send mail immediately unless you tell it to
- do otherwise by selecting <menuchoice>
- <guimenu>File</guimenu> <guimenuitem>Send
- Later</guimenuitem></menuchoice>. That will add messages
- to the <guilabel>Outbox</guilabel> queue. Then, when you
- press <guibutton>Send</guibutton> in another message, or
- <guibutton>Get Mail</guibutton> in the main mail window,
- all your unsent messages will go out at once. I like to
- use "Send Later" because it gives me a chance to change my
- mind about a message before it goes out. That way, I don't
- send anything I'll regret the next day.
- </para>
- <para>
- To learn more about how you can specify message queue and
- filter behavior, see <xref linkend="config-prefs-mail">.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- You can also choose to save messages as drafts or as text
- files. Choose
- <menuchoice>
- <guimenu>File</guimenu>
- <guimenuitem>Save</guimenuitem>
- </menuchoice>
- or <guimenuitem>Save As</guimenuitem> to save your message
- as a text file. If you prefer to keep your message in a
- folder (the <guilabel>Drafts</guilabel> folder would be the
- obvious place), you can select <menuchoice>
- <guimenu>File</guimenu> <guimenuitem>Save In
- Folder</guimenuitem> </menuchoice>.
- </para>
- </sect3>
- <sect3 id="usage-mail-getnsend-send-compose">
- <title>Advanced Mail Composition</title>
- <para>
- You can probably guess the purpose of the buttons labelled
- <guibutton>Cut</guibutton>, <guibutton>Copy</guibutton>,
- <guibutton>Paste</guibutton>, <guibutton>Undo</guibutton>
- and <guibutton>Redo</guibutton>, but there's a bit more to
- sending mail that's less obvious. In the next few sections,
- you'll see how <application>Evolution</application> handles
- additional features, including large recipient lists,
- attachments, and forwarding.
- </para>
- <sect4 id="usage-mail-getnsend-send-attach">
- <title>Attachments</title>
- <para>
- If you want to attach a file to your email message, you
- can drag it from your desktop into the message window, or
- click the button in the toolbar with a paper clip on it,
- labelled <guibutton>Attach</guibutton>. If you click the
- <guibutton>Attach</guibutton> button,
- <application>Evolution</application> will open a file
- selection dialog box, to ask you which file you want to
- send. Select the file and click <guilabel>OK</guilabel>.
- </para>
- <para>
- To see what files you've attached to the message you're
- composing, select <menuchoice> <guimenu>View</guimenu>
- <guimenuitem>Show Attachments</guimenuitem> </menuchoice>;
- to hide them again, choose <guimenuitem>Hide
- Attachments</guimenuitem>.
- </para>
- <para>
- When you send the message, a copy of the attached file
- will go with it. Be aware that big attachments can take a
- long time to download.
- </para>
- </sect4>
- <sect4 id="usage-mail-getnsend-send-to-types">
- <title>Types of Recipients</title>
- <para>
- <application>Evolution</application>, like all email
- programs (at least, all the ones in current use)
- recognizes three types of addressee: primary recipients,
- secondary recipients, and hidden ("blind") recipients.
- </para>
- <para>
- The simplest way to direct a message is to put the email
- address or addresses in the <guilabel>To:</guilabel>
- field, which denotes primary recipients. However, it's
- considered bad form to have more than a few email
- addresses in this section. If you are sending mail to
- more than one or two people, consider the
- <guilabel>Cc:</guilabel> field.
- </para>
- <para>
- Hearkening back to the dark ages when people used
- typewriters and there were no copy machines, "Cc" stands
- for "Carbon Copy." Use it whenever you want to share a
- message you've written to someone else.
- <example id="ex-mail-cc">
- <title>Using the Cc: field</title>
- <para>
- When Susan sends an email to a client, she puts her
- co-worker, Tim, in the in the
- <guilabel>Cc:</guilabel> field, so that he know
- what's going on. The client can see that Tim also
- received the message, and knows that he can talk to
- Tim about the message as well.
- </para>
- </example>
- </para>
- <para>
- If you have a large number of recipients, or if you want
- to send mail to several people without sharing the
- recipient list, you should use
- <guilabel>Bcc:</guilabel>. "Bcc" stands for "Blind Carbon
- Copy", and means that people you put in the
- <guilabel>Bcc:</guilabel> field get the message, but
- nobody else sees their email address. They will still see
- the list of addresses from the <guilabel>To:</guilabel>
- and <guilabel>Cc:</guilabel> fields, though.
-
- <example id="ex-mail-bcc">
- <title>Using the Bcc: field</title>
- <para>
- Tim is sending an email announcement to all of his
- company's clients, some of whom are in competition
- with each other, and all of whom value their
- privacy. He needs to use the
- <guilabel>Bcc:</guilabel> field here. If he puts
- every address from his address book's "Clients"
- category into the <guilabel>To:</guilabel> or
- <guilabel>Cc:</guilabel> fields, he'll make the
- company's <emphasis>entire</emphasis> client list
- public. Don't assume it won't happen to you!
- </para>
- </example>
- </para>
- </sect4>
-
- <sect4 id="usage-mail-getnsend-send-to">
- <title>Choosing Recipients Quickly</title>
- <para>
- If you have created address cards in the contact manager,
- you can also enter nicknames or other portions of address
- data, and <application>Evolution</application> will complete
- the address for you. <!-- (INSERT description of UI for this
- feature, once it is decided upon). --> If you enter a name
- or nickname that can go with more than one card, Evolution
- will open a dialog box to ask you which person you meant.
- <!-- (NOT YET) Also, <application>Evolution</application>
- will add a domain to any unqualified addresses. By default,
- this is your domain, but you can choose which one mail
- preferences dialog. -->
- </para>
- <para>
- Alternately, you can click on the
- <guibutton>To:</guibutton>, <guibutton>Cc:</guibutton>, or
- <guibutton>Bcc:</guibutton> buttons to get a list &mdash;
- potentially a very long one &mdash; of the email addresses
- in your contact manager. Select addresses and click on
- the arrows to move them into the appropriate address
- columns.
- </para>
- <para>
- For more information about using email together with the
- contact manager and the calendar, see <xref
- linkend="usage-contact-automate"> and <xref
- linkend="usage-calendar-apts">.
- </para>
- </sect4>
- </sect3>
-
- <sect3 id="usage-mail-getnsend-send-reply">
- <title>Replying to Messages</title>
- <para>
- To reply to a message, press the
- <guibutton>Reply</guibutton> button while it is selected,
- or choose <guimenuitem>Reply to Sender</guimenuitem> from
- the message's right-click menu. That will open
- <interface>message composer</interface>. The
- <guilabel>To:</guilabel> and <guilabel>Subject</guilabel>
- fields will already be filled, although you can alter them
- if you wish. In addition, the full text of the old message
- is inserted into the new message, either in italics (for
- HTML display) or with the &gt; character (in plain text
- mode) before each line, to indicate that it's part of the
- previous message. People often intersperse their message
- with the quoted material as shown in <xref
- linkend="usage-mail-getnsend-reply-fig">.
-
-<!-- note that this figure should have a reply mail ready to send,
-with quoted materials and the relevant replies interspersed-->
- <!-- ==============Figure=================================== -->
- <figure id="usage-mail-getnsend-reply-fig">
- <title>Reply Message Window</title>
- <screenshot>
- <screeninfo>Evolution Main Window</screeninfo>
- <graphic fileref="fig/replymsg" format="png" srccredit="Aaron Weber">
- </graphic>
- </screenshot>
- </figure>
-<!-- ==============End of Figure=================================== -->
- </para>
-
- <para>
- If you're reading a message with several recipients, you may
- wish to use <guibutton>Reply to All</guibutton> instead of
- <guibutton>Reply</guibutton>. If there are large numbers
- of people in the <guilabel>Cc:</guilabel> or
- <guilabel>To:</guilabel> fields, this can save substantial
- amounts of time. But be careful, and always make sure you
- know who is getting a message: one address could be a
- mailing list with thousands of subscribers.
- <example>
- <title>Using the Reply to All feature</title>
- <para>
- Susan sends an email to a client, and sends copies to
- Tim and to an internal company mailing list of
- co-workers. If Tim wants to make a comment to all of
- them, he uses <guibutton>Reply to All</guibutton>, but
- if he just wants to tell Susan that he agrees with her,
- he uses <guibutton>Reply</guibutton>.
- </para>
- </example>
- </para>
- </sect3>
- <sect3 id="usage-mail-getnsend-send-find">
- <title>Searching and Replacing with the Composer</title>
- <para>
- You're probably familiar with search and replace features,
- and if you come from a Linux or Unix background, you
- probably know what <guimenuitem>Find Regex</guimenuitem>
- does. If you aren't among the lucky who already know,
- here's a quick rundown of an important section of the
- <guimenu>Edit</guimenu> menu.
- </para>
- <para>
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Find</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para> Enter a word or phrase, and
- <application>Evolution</application> will find it
- in your message.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Find Regex</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Perform a search for a <glossterm
- linkend="regular-expression">regular
- expression</glossterm>, or "regex."
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Find Again</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Select this item to repeat the last search you performed.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Replace</guimenuitem></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Find a word or phrase, and replace it with
- something else.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- <para>
- For all of these items, you have two additional choices.
- First, you can choose whether to <guilabel>Search
- Backwards</guilabel>, which will perform the search
- starting wherever your cursor is, and moving back towards
- the beginning of the document (normally, it goes the other
- way). Then, you can decide whether to have your search be
- <guilabel>Case Sensitive</guilabel>, meaning should it pay
- attention to the case of letters when locating a match.
- </para>
- </sect3>
- <sect3 id="usage-mail-getnsend-send-html">
- <title>Embellish your email with HTML</title>
- <para>
- You can't normally use text treatments or pictures in
- emails, which is why you've probably seen people use far
- too many exclamation points for emphasis or use <glossterm
- linkend="emoticon">emoticons</glossterm> to convey their
- feelings. However, most of the newer email programs can
- include and display images and text treatments as well as
- basic alignment and paragraph formatting. They do this
- with <glossterm linkend="html">HTML</glossterm>, just like
- web sites do.
- </para>
- <note>
- <title>HTML Mail is not a Default Setting</title>
- <para>
- Some people do not have HTML-capable mail clients, or
- prefer not to receive HTML-enhanced mail because it is
- slower to download and display. <emphasis>Some</emphasis>
- people refer to HTML mail as "the root of all evil" and
- get very angry if you send them HTML mail, which is why
- <application>Evolution</application> sends plain text
- unless you explicitly ask for HTML. To send HTML mail,
- you will need to select <menuchoice>
- <guimenu>Format</guimenu> <guimenuitem>
- HTML</guimenuitem></menuchoice>. Alternately, you can set
- your default mail format preferences in the mail
- configuration dialog. See <xref
- linkend="config-prefs-mail-other"> for more information.
- </para>
- </note>
- <para>
- HTML formatting tools are located just above the
- composition frame, and in the <guimenu>Insert</guimenu> and
- <guimenu>Format</guimenu> menus. Your message text will
- appear formatted in the composer window, and the message
- will be sent as HTML.
- </para>
- <para>
- The icons in the toolbar are explained in tool-tips, which
- appear when you hold your mouse over the buttons. The
- buttons fall into four categories:
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Headers and lists</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Choose <guilabel>Normal</guilabel> for a default
- text style, or <guilabel>Header 1</guilabel> through
- <guilabel>Header 6</guilabel> for varying sizes of
- header from large (1) to tiny (6). You can also
- select <guilabel>pre</guilabel> for preformatted
- text blocks, and three types of <guilabel>List
- Item</guilabel>.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Text style</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Use these buttons to determine the way your letters
- look. If you have text selected, the style will
- apply to the selected text. If you do not have text
- selected, the style will apply to whatever you type
- next. The buttons are:
- <itemizedlist mark="none">
- <listitem><para>Push <guibutton>B</guibutton> for bold text</para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>Push <guibutton>I</guibutton> for italics</para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>Push <guibutton>U</guibutton> to underline</para></listitem>
- <listitem><para>Push <guibutton>S</guibutton> for a strikethrough.</para></listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Alignment</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Located next to the text style buttons,
- these three paragraph icons should be familiar to
- users of most word processing software. The
- leftmost button will make your text left-justified,
- the center button, centered, and the right hand
- button, right-justified.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Indentation rules</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- The button with the arrow pointing left will reduce
- a paragraph's indentation, and the right arrow will
- increase its indentation.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term>Color Selection</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- At the far right is the color section tool. You can
- choose from several colors by clicking on the arrow,
- or create your own custom color by clicking on the
- color box itself. If you have text selected, the
- color will apply to the selected text. If you do
- not have text selected, the color will apply to
- whatever you type next.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
-
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- <para>
- There are three tools that you can find only in the
- <guimenu>Insert</guimenu> menu.
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Insert Link</guimenuitem>:</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Use this tool to put hyperlinks in your HTML
- messages. When you select it,
- <application>Evolution</application> will prompt you
- for the <guilabel>Text</guilabel> that will appear,
- and the <guilabel>Link</guilabel>, where you should
- enter the actual web address (URL).
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term> <guimenuitem>Insert Image</guimenuitem>:</term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <guimenuitem>Insert Image</guimenuitem>: Select this item to
- embed an image into your email, as was done in the welcome
- message. Images will appear at the location of the
- cursor.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guimenuitem>Insert Rule</guimenuitem>:</term>
- <listitem><para>
- This will insert a horizontal line, or rule, into your document.
- You'll be presented with a dialog box which gives you
- the choice of size, percentage of screen, shading, and
- alignment; if you leave everything at the default
- values you'll get a thin black rule all the way across
- the screen.</para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- <note>
- <title>A Technical note on HTML Tags</title>
- <para>
- The composer is a WYSIWYG (What You See Is What You Get)
- editor for HTML. That means that if you enter HTML
- directly into the composer&mdash; say, <markup
- role="html">&lt;B&gt;Bold Text&lt;/B&gt</markup>, the
- the composer will assume you meant exactly that string
- of characters, and not "make this text bold," as an HTML
- composition tool or text editor would.
- </para>
- </note>
- </sect3>
-
-
-<!-- Function not implemented,
-possibly never will be due to security evil. -->
-<!--
- <sect3 id="usage-mail-getnsend-send-live">
- <title>Live Documents</title>
- <para>
- Later versions of <application>Evolution</application>
- will allow you to enliven your email with almost any
- sort of document, and even with entire
- applications. At this point, however, this feature has not
- yet been implemented.
- </para>
- </sect3>
--->
-
- <sect3 id="usage-mail-getnsend-fwd">
- <title>Forwarding Mail</title>
- <para>
- The post office forwards your mail for you when you change
- addresses, and you can forward mail when you get a letter by
- mistake. The email <guilabel>Forward</guilabel> button
- works in much the same way. It's particularly useful if you
- have received a message and you think someone else would
- like to see it. You can forward a message as an attachment
- to a new message (this is the default) or
- you can send it <glossterm linkend="inline">inline</glossterm> as a quoted
- portion of the message you are sending. Attachment
- forwarding is best if you want to send the full, unaltered
- message on to someone else. Inline forwarding is best if
- you want to send portions of a message, or if you have a
- large number of comments on different sections of the
- message you are forwarding. Remember to note from whom the
- message came, and where, if at all, you have removed or
- altered content.
- </para>
- <para>
- To forward a message you are reading, press
- <guibutton>Forward</guibutton> on the toolbar, or select
- <menuchoice> <guimenu>Message</guimenu>
- <guimenuitem>Forward</guimenuitem> </menuchoice>. If you
- prefer to forward the message <glossterm linkend="inline">inline</glossterm>
- instead of attached, select <menuchoice>
- <guimenu>Message</guimenu> <guimenuitem>Forward
- Inline</guimenuitem> </menuchoice> from the menu. Choose an
- addressee as you would when sending a new message; the
- subject will already be entered, but you can alter it.
- Enter your comments on the message in the
- <interface>composition frame</interface>, and press
- <guibutton>Send</guibutton>.
- </para>
- </sect3>
- <sect3 id="usage-mail-getnsend-ettiquette">
- <title>Seven Tips for Email Usage</title>
- <para>
- I started with ten, but four were "Don't send
- <glossterm linkend="spam">spam</glossterm>."
- <itemizedlist>
-
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Don't send spam or forward chain mail. If you must,
- watch out for hoaxes and urban legends, and make sure
- the message doesn't have multiple layers of
- greater-than signs, (&gt;) indicating multiple layers
- of careless inline forwarding.
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Always begin and close with a salutation. Say
- "please" and "thank you", just like you do in real
- life. You can keep your pleasantries short, but be pleasant!
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem>
- <para>
- ALL CAPS MEANS YOU'RE SHOUTING! Don't write a whole
- message in capital letters. It hurts people's ears.
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Never write anything in email you wouldn't say in
- public. Old messages have a nasty habit of
- resurfacing when you least expect.
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Check your spelling and use complete sentences.
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Don't send nasty emails (flames). If you get one,
- don't write back.
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem>
- <para>
- When you reply or forward, include just enough of
- the previous message to provide context: not too
- much, not too little.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </para>
- <para> Happy mailing! </para>
- </sect3>
- </sect2>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="usage-mail-organize">
- <title>Organizing Your Mail</title>
- <para>
- Even if you only get a few email messages a day, you probably
- want to sort and organize them. When you get a hundred a day
- and you want to refer to a message you received six weeks ago,
- you <emphasis>need</emphasis> to sort and organize them.
- Fortunately, <application>Evolution</application> has the tools
- to help you do it.
- </para>
-
- <sect2 id="usage-mail-organize-folders">
- <title>Getting Organized with Folders</title>
- <para>
- <application>Evolution</application> keeps mail, as well as
- address cards and calendars, in folders. You start out with a
- few, like <guilabel>Inbox</guilabel>,
- <guilabel>Outbox</guilabel>, and <guilabel>Drafts</guilabel>,
- but you can create as many as you like. Create new folders by
- selecting <guisubmenu>New</guisubmenu> and then
- <guimenuitem>Folder</guimenuitem> from the
- <guimenu>File</guimenu> menu.
- <application>Evolution</application> will as you for the name
- and the type of the folder, and will provide you with a folder
- tree so you can pick where it goes.
- </para>
- <para>
- When you click <guibutton>OK</guibutton>, your new folder will
- appear in the <interface>folder view</interface>. You can
- then put messages in it by dragging and dropping them, or by
- using the <guibutton>Move</guibutton> button in the toolbar.
- If you create a filter with the <interface>filter
- assistant</interface>, you can have mail moved to your folder
- automatically.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="usage-mail-organize-search">
- <title>Searching for Messages</title>
- <para>
- Most mail clients can search through your messages for you,
- but <application>Evolution</application> does it faster. You
- can search through just the message subjects, just the message
- body, or both body and subject.
- </para>
- <para>
- To start searching, enter a word or phrase in the text area
- right below the toolbar, and choose a search type:
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Body or subject contains:</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- This will search message subjects and the messages
- themselves for the word or phrase you've entered in
- the search field.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term> <guilabel>Body contains:</guilabel> </term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- This will search only in message text, not the subject
- lines.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Subject contains:</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- This will show you messages where the search text is
- in the subject line. It will not search in the
- message body.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Body does not contain:</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- This finds every email message that does not have the
- search text in the message body. It will still show
- messages that have the search text in the subject
- line, if it is not also in the body.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Subject does not contain:</guilabel></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- This finds every mail whose subject does not contain
- the search text.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
-
- Then, press <keycap>Enter</keycap>.
- <application>Evolution</application> will show your search
- results in the message list.
-
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="usage-mail-organize-filters">
- <title>Staying organized: Mail Filters in Evolution</title>
- <para>
- I once worked in the mail room of a large company, where my
- job was to bundle, sort, and distribute mail to the various
- mail boxes and desks throughout the building. Filters do that
- same job with email, but they lose much less mail than I did.
- In addition, you can have multiple filters performing multiple
- actions that may effect the same message in several ways. For
- example, your filters could put copies of one message into
- multiple folders, or keep a copy and send one to another
- person as well. Which is to say, it's quite a bit more
- flexible than an actual person with a pile of envelopes.
- </para>
- <para>
- Most often, you'll want to have
- <application>Evolution</application> put mail into different
- folders, but you can have it do almost anything you like.
- People who subscribe to multiple mailing lists, or who often
- need to refer to messages they have sent, find filters
- especially helpful to separate personal from list-related
- mail, but they're good for anybody who gets more than a few
- messages a day. To create a filter, open the
- <interface>filter assistant</interface> by selecting
- <menuchoice>
- <guimenu>Tools</guimenu>
- <guimenuitem>Mail Filters</guimenuitem>
- </menuchoice>.
- </para>
-
- <figure id="usage-mail-filters-fig-assist">
- <title>The Filter Assistant</title>
- <screenshot>
- <screeninfo>The Filter Assistant</screeninfo>
- <graphic fileref="fig/filter-assist-fig" format="png" srccredit="Aaron Weber">
- </graphic>
- </screenshot>
- </figure>
-
- <para>
- The <interface>filter assistant</interface> window contains a
- list of your current filters, sorted by the order in which
- they will be performed. From the drop-down box at the top of
- the window, choose <guilabel>Incoming</guilabel> to display
- those filters which are performed on incoming mail, and
- <guilabel>On Demand</guilabel> for those which are performed
- only when you want.
- </para>
- <para>
- The <interface>filter assistant</interface> also has a set of
- buttons:
- <itemizedlist>
-
- <listitem><para>
- <guibutton>Add</guibutton> &mdash; Create a new filter.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- <guibutton>Edit</guibutton> &mdash; Edit an existing filter.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- <guibutton>Delete</guibutton> &mdash; Delete the selected filter.
- </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para> <guibutton>Up</guibutton> &mdash; Move the
- selected filter up in the list, so it will be performed
- sooner. </para></listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>
- <guibutton>Down</guibutton> &mdash; Move the selected filter down
- in the list, so it will be performed later.
- </para></listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
-
- If you don't have any filters set up, the only one of those
- buttons you can click is <guibutton>Add</guibutton>. When you
- do that, (or when you click <guibutton>Edit</guibutton> with a
- filter selected), the <interface>Add Rule</interface> window
- appears.
- </para>
- <para>
- That window, shown in <xref
- linkend="usage-mail-filters-fig-new">, is where you'll
- actually create your filtering rule.
-
- <figure id="usage-mail-filters-fig-new">
- <title>Creating a new Filter</title>
- <screenshot>
- <screeninfo>Creating a new Filter</screeninfo>
- <graphic fileref="fig/filter-new-fig" format="png" srccredit="Aaron Weber">
- </graphic>
- </screenshot>
- </figure>
- </para>
- <para>
- Enter a name for your filter in the <guilabel>Rule
- Name</guilabel> field, and then begin choosing criteria.
- Choose how many criteria you'd like by pressing <guibutton>Add
- Criterion</guibutton> and <guibutton>Remove
- Criterion</guibutton>. If you have multiple criteria, you
- should then decide whether to have the filter do its job only
- <guilabel>if all criteria are met</guilabel>, or <guilabel>if
- any criteria are met</guilabel>.
- </para>
- <para>
- For each of your filter criteria, you must first select what
- part of the message you want the filter to look at:
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Sender</guilabel></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The author of the message.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Recipients</guilabel></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The recipients of the message.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Subject</guilabel></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The subject line of the message.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Specific Header</guilabel></term>
- <listitem><para> The filter can look at any header you
- want, even obscure or custom ones like X-Bonus or
- X-Archive. Enter the header name, and what you'd like to
- match inside it. </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Message Body</guilabel></term>
- <listitem><para>
- The actual text of the message.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Expression</guilabel></term>
- <listitem><para> Enter a <glossterm
- linkend="regular-expression">regular
- expression</glossterm>, and
- <application>Evolution</application> will search the
- entire message, headers and all, to match it for you.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Date Sent</guilabel></term>
- <listitem><para>
- You can filter messages by when they were sent: First,
- choose how you'd like to match the time&mdash;
- <guilabel>before</guilabel>,
- <guilabel>after</guilabel> and so forth. Then, choose
- the time. The filter compare the message's time-stamp
- to the system clock when the filter is run, or to a
- specific time and date you choose from a calendar.
- You can even have it look for messages within a range
- of time relative to the filter. For example, you could have
- the filter catch all messages sent less
- than a week before the filter is run.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Date Recieved</guilabel></term>
- <listitem><para>
- This works the same way as the <guilabel>Date Sent</guilabel>
- option, except that it compares the time you got the message
- with the dates you specify.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Priority</guilabel></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Emails have a standard priority range from -3 (least
- important) to 3 (most important). If you can persuade
- your friends and co-workers to use the priority levels
- honestly, you can filter with them as well.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- <para>
- Now, tell it what to do with those messages. If you want multiple
- actions, click <guibutton>Add Action</guibutton>; if you want fewer,
- click <guibutton>Remove Action</guibutton>. And choose again:
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Move to Folder</guilabel></term>
- <listitem><para>
- If you select this item, <application>Evolution</application>
- will put the messages into a folder you specify. Click the
- <guibutton>&lt;click here to select a folder&gt;</guibutton> button
- to select a folder.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Forward to Address</guilabel></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Select this, enter an address, and the addressee will
- get a copy of the message.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Delete</guilabel></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Marks the message for deletion. You can still get the message
- back, at least until you <guimenuitem>Expunge</guimenuitem> your
- mail yourself.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Stop Processing</guilabel></term>
- <listitem><para> Select this if you want to tell all other
- filters to ignore this message. If multiple filters copy
- the message to a different folders, you'll have multiple
- copies of the message. </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Assign Color</guilabel></term>
- <listitem><para>
- Select this item, and <application>Evolution</application>
- will mark the message with whatever color you please.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guilabel>Assign Score</guilabel></term>
- <listitem><para> Priority numbers alone don't work, so you
- can score emails on the same scale. Then, you can tell
- which ones you want to read, or have scored messages
- moved, copied, or colored in a subsequent filter.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- <para>
- You're done. Click <guibutton>OK</guibutton> to use this
- filter, or <guibutton>Cancel</guibutton> to close the window
- without saving any changes.
- </para>
-
-
-
- <!-- FIXME: This needs to be in there. But the feature is temporarily
- disabled and I don't know how it will be reimplemented.
-
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <guilabel>When mail arrives:</guilabel> Select
- this option to have messages filtered as they
- arrive.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <guilabel>When mail is sent:</guilabel> Select
- this option to filter your outgoing mail. You
- can use this feature to keep your
- <interface>Outbox</interface> as organized as
- your <interface>Inbox</interface>.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </para>
-
- -->
-
- <note>
- <title>Two Notable Filter Features</title>
- <para>
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem><para>
- Incoming email that your filters don't move goes into the Inbox;
- outgoing mail that they don't move ends up in the Sent folder.
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem><para>If you move a folder, your filters
- will follow it. </para></listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </para>
- </note>
- </sect2>
-
-
-
- <sect2 id="usage-mail-organize-vFolders">
- <title>Getting Really Organized with Virtual Folders</title>
- <para>
- If filters aren't flexible enough for you, or you find
- yourself performing the same search again and again, consider
- a virtual folder. Virtual folders, or vFolders, are an
- advanced way of viewing your email messages within
- <application>Evolution</application>. If you get a lot of
- mail or often forget where you put messages, vFolders can help
- you stay on top of things.
- </para>
- <para>
- A vFolder is really a hybrid of all the other organizational
- tools: it looks like a folder, it acts like a search, and you
- set it up like a filter. In other words, while a conventional
- folder actually contains messages, a vFolder is a view of
- messages that may be in several different folders. The
- messages it contains are determined on the fly using a set of
- criteria you choose in advance.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- As messages that meet the vFolder criteria arrive or are
- deleted, <application>Evolution</application> will
- automatically place them in and and remove them from the
- vFolder contents list. When you delete a message, it gets
- erased from the folder in which it actually exists, as well as
- any vFolders which display it.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Imagine a business trying to keep track of mail from hundreds
- of vendors and clients, or a university with overlapping and
- changing groups of faculty, staff, administrators and
- students. The more mail you need to organize, the less you
- can afford the sort of confusion that stems from an
- organizational system that's not flexible enough. vFolders
- make for better organization because they can accept
- overlapping groups in a way that regular folders and filing
- systems can't.
- </para>
-
- <example id="usage-mail-organize-vFolders-ex">
- <title>Using Folders, Searches, and vFolders</title>
- <para>
- To organize my mail box, I set up a vFolder for emails from
- my friend and co-worker Anna. I have another one for
- messages from anybody at work that have "Evolution" in the
- subject line, so I can keep a record of what people from
- work send me about <application>Evolution</application>.
- If Anna sends a message about a picnic on Saturday, it only
- shows up in the "Anna" folder. When Anna sends me mail
- about the user interface for
- <application>Evolution</application>, I can see that
- message both in the "Anna" vFolder and in the "Internal
- Evolution Discussion" vFolder.
- </para>
- </example>
-
- <!-- (INSERT SCREENSHOT HERE: vFolders in action) -->
-
- <para>
- To create a vFolder, select <menuchoice>
- <guimenu>Tools</guimenu> <guimenuitem>vFolder
- Editor</guimenuitem> </menuchoice>. This will bring up a
- dialog box that looks suspiciously like the filter window
- (for more information on filters, see <xref
- linkend="usage-mail-organize-filters">), and which
- presents you with a list of vFolders you have previously
- created. If you have created any vFolders, they are listed
- here, and you can select, edit or remove them if you wish.
- If you have not created any, there will be only one available
- option: click <guibutton>Add</guibutton> to add a new
- vFolder.
- </para>
- <para>
- You can enter a name for your vFolder in the
- <guilabel>Name</guilabel>. Then, tell
- <application>Evolution</application> what messages to look
- for. This process is exactly like filter creation: decide
- between <guilabel>Match all parts</guilabel> and
- <guilabel>Match any part</guilabel>, then choose what part of
- the message to look in, what sort of matching to perform, and
- specify exactly what it is that you want to find, be it a
- line of text, a score, a regular expression, or a particular date or
- range of dates.
- </para>
- <para>
- The second part, however, is slightly different. In the
- section of the window labelled <guilabel>vFolder Sources
- </guilabel> is a list of folders in which
- <application>Evolution</application> will search for the
- contents of your vFolder. Click <guibutton>Add</guibutton>
- to add a folder, or <guibutton>Remove</guibutton> to remove
- one. That way, you can have your vFolder search in
- newsgroups, or just in one of your mailboxes, or just in a
- select few folders you've already screened with filters.
- </para>
- <para>
- The vFolder creation window is shown in <xref
- linkend="usage-mail-vfolder-fig-createrule">
-
- <figure id="usage-mail-vfolder-fig-createrule">
- <title>Selecting a vFolder Rule</title>
- <screenshot>
- <screeninfo>Creating a vFolder Rule</screeninfo>
- <graphic fileref="fig/vfolder-createrule-fig" format="png" srccredit="Aaron Weber">
- </graphic>
- </screenshot>
- </figure>
- </para>
- </sect2>
- <sect2 id="usage-mail-subscriptions">
- <title>Subscription Management</title>
- <para>
- <application>Evolution</application> lets you handle your
- IMAP and newsgroup subscriptions with the same tool: the
- subscriptions manager. To start using it, choose
- <menuchoice> <guimenu>Settings</guimenu> <guimenuitem>Manage
- Subscriptions</guimenuitem> </menuchoice>.
- </para>
- </sect2>
- </sect1>
-</chapter>
-
diff --git a/doc/C/usage-mainwindow.sgml b/doc/C/usage-mainwindow.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index c6a252ac78..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/usage-mainwindow.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,424 +0,0 @@
-<!--
- <!DOCTYPE Chapter PUBLIC "-//GNOME//DTD DocBook PNG Variant V1.1//EN">
--->
-<chapter id="usage-mainwindow">
-
- <title>The Main Window: Evolution Basics</title>
- <para>
- Start <application>Evolution</application> by selecting
- <menuchoice><guimenu>Main Panel Menu</guimenu>
- <guisubmenu>Applications</guisubmenu>
- <guimenuitem>Evolution</guimenuitem></menuchoice> or by typing
- <command>evolution</command> at the command line. The first time
- you run the program, it will create a directory called
- <filename>evolution</filename> in your home directory, where it
- will keep all your <application>Evolution</application>-related
- files.
- </para>
- <para>
- After <application>Evolution</application> starts
- up, you will see the <interface>main window</interface>, with the
- <interface>Inbox</interface> open. It should look a lot like the
- picture in <xref linkend="usage-mainwindow-fig">. On the left of
- the <interface>main window</interface> is the <interface>shortcut
- bar</interface>, with several buttons in it. Just underneath the
- title bar is a series of menus in the <interface>menu
- bar</interface>, and below that, the <interface>tool
- bar</interface> with buttons for different functions. The largest
- part of the <interface>main window</interface> is taken up by the
- actual <interface>Inbox</interface>, where messages are listed
- and displayed. If you're running the program for the first time,
- you'll have just one message: a welcome from Helix Code.
-
-
-<!-- ==============Figure=================================== -->
- <figure id="usage-mainwindow-fig">
- <title>Evolution Main Window and Inbox</title>
- <screenshot>
- <screeninfo>Evolution Main Window</screeninfo>
- <graphic fileref="fig/mainwindow-pic" format="png" srccredit="Kevin Breit">
- </graphic>
- </screenshot>
- </figure>
-<!-- ==============End of Figure=================================== -->
-</para>
-
- <para>
- <note>
- <title>The Way Evolution Looks</title>
- <para>
- The appearance of both <application>Evolution</application>
- and <application>GNOME</application> is very easy to
- customize, so your screen might not look like this picture.
- You might decide to have <application>Evolution</application>
- start with the calendar and a folder bar, or with the contact
- manager occupying the entire window.
- </para>
- </note>
- </para>
-
- <sect1 id="usage-mainwindow-shortcutbar">
- <title>The Shortcut Bar</title>
- <para>
- <application>Evolution</application>'s most important job is
- to give you access to your information and help you use it
- quickly. One way it does that is through the
- <interface>shortcut bar</interface>, the column on the left
- hand side of the main window. The large buttons with names
- like <guilabel>Inbox</guilabel> and
- <guilabel>Contacts</guilabel> are the shortcuts, and you can
- select different groups of shortcuts by clicking the
- rectangular group buttons.
- </para>
- <para>
- The shortcut group buttons are <guibutton>Evolution
- Shortcuts</guibutton> and <guibutton>Internet
- Directories</guibutton>. When you click on them, they'll slide
- up and down to give you access to different sorts of shortcuts.
- When you first start <application>Evolution</application>, you
- are looking at the <guilabel>Evolution Shortcuts</guilabel>
- category. If you click <guilabel>Internet
- Directories</guilabel>, it will slide up and you'll see buttons
- for the <guilabel>Bigfoot</guilabel> and
- <guilabel>Netcenter</guilabel> directories, as well as any
- others you or your system administrator might have added. You
- can add more groups by right-clicking on the background of the
- shortcut bar and selecting <guimenuitem>Menu
- Group</guimenuitem>. Internet directories behave a lot like
- the local contact manager, which is covered in <xref
- linkend="usage-contact">.
- </para>
- <para>
- Take a look at the <guilabel>Evolution Shortcuts</guilabel>
- again. The shortcut buttons in that category are:
-
- <variablelist>
-
-<!-- NOT IMPLEMENTED!
- <varlistentry>
- <term> <guibutton>Today:</guibutton></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- This will bring up a summary of any new messages you've
- received, along with the tasks and appointments you have
- lined up for today.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
--->
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term> <guibutton>Inbox:</guibutton></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- The Inbox will show you all of your email. Your Inbox
- is also where you can access Evolution's tools to
- filter, sort, organize, and search your mail.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guibutton>Calendar:</guibutton></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- The Calendar can store your appointments and To do lists
- for you. Connected to a network, you can use it to keep
- a group of people on schedule and up to date.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term><guibutton>Contacts:</guibutton></term>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- The Contact Manager holds your addresses, phone numbers,
- and contact information. Like calendar information,
- contact data can be synchronized with hand-held devices
- and shared over a network.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
-<!-- NOT IMPLEMENTED YET
- <varlistentry>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- The <guibutton>Tasks:</guibutton> tool combines a "to
- do" list with reminders to help you keep track of
- daily events.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term> <guibutton>Notes:</guibutton></term>
- <listitem>
- <para> The note pad is your catch-all tool: use it to take
- messages from phone conversations, keep small things
- organized, write <glossterm linkend="haiku">haiku</glossterm>, or whatever
- you like. This feature is not yet implemented, but will be
- soon. See <xref linkend="usage-notes"> for more
- information.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </varlistentry>
--->
-
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- <para>
- If you don't like the shortcut bar, you can use the menu bar, or
- keyboard shortcuts, also called <glossterm linkend="hot-key">hot keys</glossterm>.
- They're shown next to their equivalent menu items in the menu
- bar. You can also set your own hot keys for functions that don't
- have any; this is covered in <xref linkend="config">. If you're
- using the keyboard shortcuts you may also want to hide the
- <interface>shortcut bar</interface> by selecting <menuchoice>
- <guimenu>View</guimenu> <guimenuitem>Show Shortcut
- Bar</guimenuitem> </menuchoice>.
- </para>
-
- <tip>
- <title>Shortcut Bar Tricks</title>
- <para>
- To remove a shortcut from the shortcut bar, right-click on it
- and select <guimenuitem>Remove</guimenuitem>. To add one,
- select <menuchoice> <guimenu>File</guimenu>
- <guisubmenu>New</guisubmenu> <guimenuitem>Evolution Bar
- Shortcut</guimenuitem> </menuchoice>. </para>
- <para>
- To change the way the shortcut bar looks, right-click in an
- empty space on the shortcut bar. From the menu that appears,
- you can select icon sizes.
- </para>
- </tip>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="usage-mainwindow-folderbar">
- <title>The Folder Bar</title>
- <para>
- The <interface>folder bar</interface> is a more comprehensive
- way to view the information you've stored with
- <application>Evolution</application>. It displays all your
- appointments, address cards, and email in a tree that's a lot
- like a <glossterm linkend="filetree">file
- tree</glossterm>&mdash; it starts small at the top, and branches
- downwards. On most computers, there will be three folders at the
- base. At the top are your <guilabel>vFolders</guilabel>, or
- virtual folders, discussed in <xref
- linkend="usage-mail-organize-vfolders">. After that come any
- <glossterm linkend="imap">IMAP</glossterm> mail folders you
- might have available to you over your network. The next folder
- is called <guilabel>External Directories</guilabel>, and holds
- <glossterm linkend="ldap">LDAP</glossterm> contact directories
- stored on a network. The most important one is probably
- <guilabel>Local</guilabel>, which you can use to access all the
- data that's stored on your computer. If you click on the plus
- sign plus sign next to the <guilabel>Local</guilabel> folder,
- you'll see the contents:
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <guilabel>Calendar</guilabel>, for appointments and
- event listings.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <guilabel>Contacts</guilabel>, for address cards.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <guilabel>Directories</guilabel>, for Internet contact directories.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <guilabel>Inbox</guilabel>, for incoming mail.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- <guilabel>Outbox</guilabel>, which is for drafts of
- messages and mail that's already been sent.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
-
- </para>
- <tip id="foldertips">
- <title>Navigating without the Folder Bar</title>
- <para>
- You don't need the folder bar or the shortcut bar to move
- around the main window. You can use <keycap>Tab</keycap> to
- switch from one part of the window to another, and the folder
- menu on the right side of the window just below the toolbar
- to move about the folder tree.
- </para>
- </tip>
-
- <para>
- To create a new folder, select <menuchoice>
- <guimenu>File</guimenu> <guisubmenu>New</guisubmenu>
- <guimenuitem>Folder</guimenuitem></menuchoice>. You'll be asked where you want to
- put it, and what kind of folder it should be. You can choose
- from three types: <guilabel>Mail</guilabel>, for storing mail,
- <guilabel>Calendar</guilabel> for storing calendars, and
- <guilabel>Contacts</guilabel> for storing contacts.
- </para>
-
- <note>
- <title>Folders Have Limits</title>
- <para>
- You can always place a folder inside other folders,
- regardless of folder type. However, calendars,
- contacts, and mail can't go into the same
- folder. Calendars have to go in calendar folders, mail
- in mail folders, and contacts in contact folders.
- </para>
- </note>
-
- <para>
- Right-clicking will bring up a menu for just about anything
- in GNOME, and <application>Evolution</application> is no
- exception. If you right-click on a folder, you'll have a
- menu with the following options:
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem><para><guimenuitem>View</guimenuitem>, to view a message.</para></listitem>
- <listitem><para><guimenuitem>Something else</guimenuitem>, for another purpose. </para></listitem>
- <listitem><para><guimenuitem>Something else</guimenuitem>, for another purpose. </para></listitem>
- </itemizedlist>.
- </para>
-
- <tip>
- <title>Context-Sensitive Help</title>
- <para>
- GNOME 2.0 will support context-sensitive help, which means you
- can almost always get help on an item by right-clicking it.
- If you're not sure what something is, or don't know what you
- can do with it, choosing <guimenuitem>Help</guimenuitem> from
- the right-click menu is a good way to find out.
- </para>
- </tip>
-
- <para>
- Any time new information arrives in a folder, that folder label
- is displayed in bold text.
- </para>
- <para>
- To delete a folder, right-click it and select
- <guimenuitem>Delete</guimenuitem> from the menu that pops up.
- To change the order of folders, or put one inside another, use
- drag-and-drop. To move individual
- messages, appointments, and address cards between folders, you
- can do the same thing: drag them where you want them, and
- they'll go.
- </para>
- </sect1>
- <sect1 id="usage-mainwindow-menubar">
- <title>The Menu Bar</title>
- <para>
- The <interface>menu bar</interface>'s contents will always
- provide all the possible actions for any given view of your
- data. That means that, depending on the context, menu bar items
- will change. If you're looking at your Inbox, most of the menu
- items will relate to mail; some will relate to other components
- of <application>Evolution</application> and some, especially
- those in the <guimenu>File Menu</guimenu> will relate to the
- application as a whole. The contents of the menu bar are
- described in <xref linkend="menuref">.
- </para>
- <para>
- <variablelist>
- <varlistentry>
- <term> <guimenu>File</guimenu> Menu</term>
-
- <listitem><para>
- Anything even related to a file or to the operations
- of the application generally falls under this
- menu: creating things, saving them to disk,
- printing them, and quitting the program itself.
-
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term> <guimenu>Edit</guimenu> Menu </term>
- <listitem><para>
- Although it doesn't contain anything at first,
- the <guimenu>Edit</guimenu> menu fills up with
- useful tools that help you edit text and move it around.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term> <guimenu>View</guimenu> Menu </term>
- <listitem><para>
- This menu lets you decide how <application>Evolution</application>
- should look. Some of the features control the appearance of
- <application>Evolution</application> as a whole, and others
- the way a particular kind of information appears.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term> <guimenu>Settings</guimenu> Menu </term>
- <listitem><para> Tools for configuring, changing, and
- setting up go here. For mail, that means things like
- <guimenuitem>Mail Configuration</guimenuitem> and the
- <guimenuitem>vFolder Editor</guimenuitem>. For the
- <interface>Calendar</interface> and the <interface>Contact
- Manager</interface>, it's color, network, and layout
- configuration. </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
-
- <varlistentry>
- <term> <guimenu>Help</guimenu> Menu</term>
- <listitem><para>
- Select among these items to open the
- <application>Help Browser</application>
- and read the <application>Evolution</application> manual.
- </para></listitem>
- </varlistentry>
- </variablelist>
- </para>
- <para>
- Other menus, like <guilabel>Folder</guilabel>,
- <guilabel>Message</guilabel>, and <guilabel>Actions</guilabel>,
- appear only occasionally. <guilabel>Message</guilabel> and
- <guilabel>Folder</guilabel>, for example, have commands that only
- relate to email, so they're only available when you're looking at
- email.
- </para>
- <para>
- Once you've familiarized yourself with the <interface>main
- window</interface> you can start doing things with it. We'll
- start with your email inbox, since you've got a letter waiting
- for you already.
- </para>
- </sect1>
-</chapter>
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
diff --git a/doc/C/usage-notes.sgml b/doc/C/usage-notes.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index 1ff2283128..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/usage-notes.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,49 +0,0 @@
-<chapter id="usage-notes">
- <title>Evolution Notes</title>
- <abstract>
- <title> An Overview of the Evolution Notes</title>
- <para>
- In the dark ages before email was invented, there were little
- scraps of people which people used for short-term information
- storage. These scraps of paper were called notes. Now, notes
- are an almost necessary part of our lives, albeit in electronic
- form. It only makes sense, then, that
- <application>Evolution</application> will eventually have a
- Notes feature. <application>Evolution</application> can help
- you take notes in the following ways:
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Take down phone numbers, take school notes, take phone
- messages, or even write poetry.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Color code notes to organize them, or just to
- make them look good.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Turn a note into an email or a text file.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- Write <glossterm>Haiku</glossterm>
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
- </para>
- <para>
- You can start writing notes by clicking
- <guibutton>Notes</guibutton> in the shortcut bar. Of course,
- it's not there yet. But when it is, it'll take you to the
- notepad.
- </para>
- </abstract>
-</chapter>
-
-
-
diff --git a/doc/C/usage-print.sgml b/doc/C/usage-print.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index 1af298eb42..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/usage-print.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,92 +0,0 @@
-<chapter id="usage-print">
-<title>Printing with Evolution</title>
-<para>
- This is a very short chapter, because printing with
- <application>Evolution</application> is not a complex task. Like
- most GNOME applications, <application>Evolution</application> uses
- the gnome-print system, so if you've used any other GNOME
- application to print, you should be able to print from
- <application>Evolution</application> immediately.
-</para>
-<para>
- Whether you're printing a message, a calendar page, or a selection
- of address cards, you can choose to print directly to a printer, or
- save the print output to a postscript file. You can also use the
- preview feature to see how your printed output will look.
-</para>
-
- <sect1 id="printpreview">
- <title>Print Preview</title>
- <para>
- <guibutton>Print Preview</guibutton>, appears both as a button
- in the printing dialog and as an item in the
- <guimenu>File</guimenu> menu. In both places, it does the same
- thing: it opens a new window that displays an image of the current
- message, calendar, appointment, or address card.
- </para>
- <para>
- That window allows you to select which pages you want to see,
- and how close you'd like to look at them. Zoom in or out, fit
- the page to the window (<guibutton>Fit</guibutton>) or match the
- width of the page and the window (<guibutton>Fit
- Width</guibutton>). If you're satisfied with the way it looks,
- click <guibutton>Print</guibutton> to send your document on its way.
- </para>
-
-
- <!-- ==============Figure=================================== -->
-
- <figure id="print-preview">
- <title>Print Preview</title>
- <screenshot>
- <screeninfo>Print Preview</screeninfo>
- <graphic fileref="fig/print-preview" format="png" srccredit="Aaron Weber">
- </graphic>
- </screenshot>
- </figure>
-<!-- ==============End of Figure============================== -->
-
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="print-destination">
- <title>File or Printer?</title>
- <para>
- The printer selection window, shown in <xref
- linkend="print-dest">, lets you choose the format for
- printing&mdash; at this time, only <guilabel>Generic
- Postscript</guilabel> is available&mdash; and whether to print
- to a file or to an actual printer. If you choose a printer,
- you'll be asked for the printer command (probably
- <guilabel>lpr</guilabel>) which your system uses. If you
- choose to print to a file, you'll need to decide upon a
- filename. And of course, you'll want to choose a number of
- copies, and whether to collate them.
- </para>
-
- <!-- ==============Figure=================================== -->
-
- <figure id="print-dest">
- <title>Choosing a Printer</title>
- <screenshot>
- <screeninfo>Choosing a Printer</screeninfo>
- <graphic fileref="fig/print-dest" format="png" srccredit="Aaron Weber">
- </graphic>
- </screenshot>
- </figure>
-<!-- ==============End of Figure============================== -->
-
- <para>
- If you're printing a message that's more than one page, you'll
- have the option of choosing which pages to print. If you're
- printing a calendar entry, you can decide what range of dates to
- print. And, if you're printing contact cards, you can decide
- whether to print only the selected cards, or all of them.
- </para>
- <para>
- When you're ready, click <guibutton>Print</guibutton> to print,
- <guibutton>Preview</guibutton> to have a look (or another look)
- at the preview, or <guibutton>Cancel</guibutton> to cancel the
- whole deal.
- </para>
- </sect1>
-</chapter>
diff --git a/doc/C/usage-sync.sgml b/doc/C/usage-sync.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index a6b53e9526..0000000000
--- a/doc/C/usage-sync.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,20 +0,0 @@
-
- <chapter id="usage-sync">
- <title>Synchronizing with a Hand-held Device</title>
- <para>
- This chapter covers is how to synchronize data
- installed and configured. If you need information on how to
- set up a synchronization system, consult <xref
- linkend="config-sync">.
- </para>
- <sect1 id="hotsync">
- <title>Using HotSync</title>
- <para>
- Put your hand-held device on its cradle and press the
- HotSync button.
- </para>
- <para>
- No, really. That's all there is to it.
- </para>
- </sect1>
- </chapter> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/doc/COPYING-DOCS b/doc/COPYING-DOCS
deleted file mode 100644
index b42936beb3..0000000000
--- a/doc/COPYING-DOCS
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,355 +0,0 @@
- GNU Free Documentation License
- Version 1.1, March 2000
-
- Copyright (C) 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
- 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA
- Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
- of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
-
-
-0. PREAMBLE
-
-The purpose of this License is to make a manual, textbook, or other
-written document "free" in the sense of freedom: to assure everyone
-the effective freedom to copy and redistribute it, with or without
-modifying it, either commercially or noncommercially. Secondarily,
-this License preserves for the author and publisher a way to get
-credit for their work, while not being considered responsible for
-modifications made by others.
-
-This License is a kind of "copyleft", which means that derivative
-works of the document must themselves be free in the same sense. It
-complements the GNU General Public License, which is a copyleft
-license designed for free software.
-
-We have designed this License in order to use it for manuals for free
-software, because free software needs free documentation: a free
-program should come with manuals providing the same freedoms that the
-software does. But this License is not limited to software manuals;
-it can be used for any textual work, regardless of subject matter or
-whether it is published as a printed book. We recommend this License
-principally for works whose purpose is instruction or reference.
-
-
-1. APPLICABILITY AND DEFINITIONS
-
-This License applies to any manual or other work that contains a
-notice placed by the copyright holder saying it can be distributed
-under the terms of this License. The "Document", below, refers to any
-such manual or work. Any member of the public is a licensee, and is
-addressed as "you".
-
-A "Modified Version" of the Document means any work containing the
-Document or a portion of it, either copied verbatim, or with
-modifications and/or translated into another language.
-
-A "Secondary Section" is a named appendix or a front-matter section of
-the Document that deals exclusively with the relationship of the
-publishers or authors of the Document to the Document's overall subject
-(or to related matters) and contains nothing that could fall directly
-within that overall subject. (For example, if the Document is in part a
-textbook of mathematics, a Secondary Section may not explain any
-mathematics.) The relationship could be a matter of historical
-connection with the subject or with related matters, or of legal,
-commercial, philosophical, ethical or political position regarding
-them.
-
-The "Invariant Sections" are certain Secondary Sections whose titles
-are designated, as being those of Invariant Sections, in the notice
-that says that the Document is released under this License.
-
-The "Cover Texts" are certain short passages of text that are listed,
-as Front-Cover Texts or Back-Cover Texts, in the notice that says that
-the Document is released under this License.
-
-A "Transparent" copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy,
-represented in a format whose specification is available to the
-general public, whose contents can be viewed and edited directly and
-straightforwardly with generic text editors or (for images composed of
-pixels) generic paint programs or (for drawings) some widely available
-drawing editor, and that is suitable for input to text formatters or
-for automatic translation to a variety of formats suitable for input
-to text formatters. A copy made in an otherwise Transparent file
-format whose markup has been designed to thwart or discourage
-subsequent modification by readers is not Transparent. A copy that is
-not "Transparent" is called "Opaque".
-
-Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain
-ASCII without markup, Texinfo input format, LaTeX input format, SGML
-or XML using a publicly available DTD, and standard-conforming simple
-HTML designed for human modification. Opaque formats include
-PostScript, PDF, proprietary formats that can be read and edited only
-by proprietary word processors, SGML or XML for which the DTD and/or
-processing tools are not generally available, and the
-machine-generated HTML produced by some word processors for output
-purposes only.
-
-The "Title Page" means, for a printed book, the title page itself,
-plus such following pages as are needed to hold, legibly, the material
-this License requires to appear in the title page. For works in
-formats which do not have any title page as such, "Title Page" means
-the text near the most prominent appearance of the work's title,
-preceding the beginning of the body of the text.
-
-
-2. VERBATIM COPYING
-
-You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium, either
-commercially or noncommercially, provided that this License, the
-copyright notices, and the license notice saying this License applies
-to the Document are reproduced in all copies, and that you add no other
-conditions whatsoever to those of this License. You may not use
-technical measures to obstruct or control the reading or further
-copying of the copies you make or distribute. However, you may accept
-compensation in exchange for copies. If you distribute a large enough
-number of copies you must also follow the conditions in section 3.
-
-You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated above, and
-you may publicly display copies.
-
-
-3. COPYING IN QUANTITY
-
-If you publish printed copies of the Document numbering more than 100,
-and the Document's license notice requires Cover Texts, you must enclose
-the copies in covers that carry, clearly and legibly, all these Cover
-Texts: Front-Cover Texts on the front cover, and Back-Cover Texts on
-the back cover. Both covers must also clearly and legibly identify
-you as the publisher of these copies. The front cover must present
-the full title with all words of the title equally prominent and
-visible. You may add other material on the covers in addition.
-Copying with changes limited to the covers, as long as they preserve
-the title of the Document and satisfy these conditions, can be treated
-as verbatim copying in other respects.
-
-If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to fit
-legibly, you should put the first ones listed (as many as fit
-reasonably) on the actual cover, and continue the rest onto adjacent
-pages.
-
-If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document numbering
-more than 100, you must either include a machine-readable Transparent
-copy along with each Opaque copy, or state in or with each Opaque copy
-a publicly-accessible computer-network location containing a complete
-Transparent copy of the Document, free of added material, which the
-general network-using public has access to download anonymously at no
-charge using public-standard network protocols. If you use the latter
-option, you must take reasonably prudent steps, when you begin
-distribution of Opaque copies in quantity, to ensure that this
-Transparent copy will remain thus accessible at the stated location
-until at least one year after the last time you distribute an Opaque
-copy (directly or through your agents or retailers) of that edition to
-the public.
-
-It is requested, but not required, that you contact the authors of the
-Document well before redistributing any large number of copies, to give
-them a chance to provide you with an updated version of the Document.
-
-
-4. MODIFICATIONS
-
-You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document under
-the conditions of sections 2 and 3 above, provided that you release
-the Modified Version under precisely this License, with the Modified
-Version filling the role of the Document, thus licensing distribution
-and modification of the Modified Version to whoever possesses a copy
-of it. In addition, you must do these things in the Modified Version:
-
-A. Use in the Title Page (and on the covers, if any) a title distinct
- from that of the Document, and from those of previous versions
- (which should, if there were any, be listed in the History section
- of the Document). You may use the same title as a previous version
- if the original publisher of that version gives permission.
-B. List on the Title Page, as authors, one or more persons or entities
- responsible for authorship of the modifications in the Modified
- Version, together with at least five of the principal authors of the
- Document (all of its principal authors, if it has less than five).
-C. State on the Title page the name of the publisher of the
- Modified Version, as the publisher.
-D. Preserve all the copyright notices of the Document.
-E. Add an appropriate copyright notice for your modifications
- adjacent to the other copyright notices.
-F. Include, immediately after the copyright notices, a license notice
- giving the public permission to use the Modified Version under the
- terms of this License, in the form shown in the Addendum below.
-G. Preserve in that license notice the full lists of Invariant Sections
- and required Cover Texts given in the Document's license notice.
-H. Include an unaltered copy of this License.
-I. Preserve the section entitled "History", and its title, and add to
- it an item stating at least the title, year, new authors, and
- publisher of the Modified Version as given on the Title Page. If
- there is no section entitled "History" in the Document, create one
- stating the title, year, authors, and publisher of the Document as
- given on its Title Page, then add an item describing the Modified
- Version as stated in the previous sentence.
-J. Preserve the network location, if any, given in the Document for
- public access to a Transparent copy of the Document, and likewise
- the network locations given in the Document for previous versions
- it was based on. These may be placed in the "History" section.
- You may omit a network location for a work that was published at
- least four years before the Document itself, or if the original
- publisher of the version it refers to gives permission.
-K. In any section entitled "Acknowledgements" or "Dedications",
- preserve the section's title, and preserve in the section all the
- substance and tone of each of the contributor acknowledgements
- and/or dedications given therein.
-L. Preserve all the Invariant Sections of the Document,
- unaltered in their text and in their titles. Section numbers
- or the equivalent are not considered part of the section titles.
-M. Delete any section entitled "Endorsements". Such a section
- may not be included in the Modified Version.
-N. Do not retitle any existing section as "Endorsements"
- or to conflict in title with any Invariant Section.
-
-If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or
-appendices that qualify as Secondary Sections and contain no material
-copied from the Document, you may at your option designate some or all
-of these sections as invariant. To do this, add their titles to the
-list of Invariant Sections in the Modified Version's license notice.
-These titles must be distinct from any other section titles.
-
-You may add a section entitled "Endorsements", provided it contains
-nothing but endorsements of your Modified Version by various
-parties--for example, statements of peer review or that the text has
-been approved by an organization as the authoritative definition of a
-standard.
-
-You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text, and a
-passage of up to 25 words as a Back-Cover Text, to the end of the list
-of Cover Texts in the Modified Version. Only one passage of
-Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover Text may be added by (or
-through arrangements made by) any one entity. If the Document already
-includes a cover text for the same cover, previously added by you or
-by arrangement made by the same entity you are acting on behalf of,
-you may not add another; but you may replace the old one, on explicit
-permission from the previous publisher that added the old one.
-
-The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this License
-give permission to use their names for publicity for or to assert or
-imply endorsement of any Modified Version.
-
-
-5. COMBINING DOCUMENTS
-
-You may combine the Document with other documents released under this
-License, under the terms defined in section 4 above for modified
-versions, provided that you include in the combination all of the
-Invariant Sections of all of the original documents, unmodified, and
-list them all as Invariant Sections of your combined work in its
-license notice.
-
-The combined work need only contain one copy of this License, and
-multiple identical Invariant Sections may be replaced with a single
-copy. If there are multiple Invariant Sections with the same name but
-different contents, make the title of each such section unique by
-adding at the end of it, in parentheses, the name of the original
-author or publisher of that section if known, or else a unique number.
-Make the same adjustment to the section titles in the list of
-Invariant Sections in the license notice of the combined work.
-
-In the combination, you must combine any sections entitled "History"
-in the various original documents, forming one section entitled
-"History"; likewise combine any sections entitled "Acknowledgements",
-and any sections entitled "Dedications". You must delete all sections
-entitled "Endorsements."
-
-
-6. COLLECTIONS OF DOCUMENTS
-
-You may make a collection consisting of the Document and other documents
-released under this License, and replace the individual copies of this
-License in the various documents with a single copy that is included in
-the collection, provided that you follow the rules of this License for
-verbatim copying of each of the documents in all other respects.
-
-You may extract a single document from such a collection, and distribute
-it individually under this License, provided you insert a copy of this
-License into the extracted document, and follow this License in all
-other respects regarding verbatim copying of that document.
-
-
-7. AGGREGATION WITH INDEPENDENT WORKS
-
-A compilation of the Document or its derivatives with other separate
-and independent documents or works, in or on a volume of a storage or
-distribution medium, does not as a whole count as a Modified Version
-of the Document, provided no compilation copyright is claimed for the
-compilation. Such a compilation is called an "aggregate", and this
-License does not apply to the other self-contained works thus compiled
-with the Document, on account of their being thus compiled, if they
-are not themselves derivative works of the Document.
-
-If the Cover Text requirement of section 3 is applicable to these
-copies of the Document, then if the Document is less than one quarter
-of the entire aggregate, the Document's Cover Texts may be placed on
-covers that surround only the Document within the aggregate.
-Otherwise they must appear on covers around the whole aggregate.
-
-
-8. TRANSLATION
-
-Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may
-distribute translations of the Document under the terms of section 4.
-Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires special
-permission from their copyright holders, but you may include
-translations of some or all Invariant Sections in addition to the
-original versions of these Invariant Sections. You may include a
-translation of this License provided that you also include the
-original English version of this License. In case of a disagreement
-between the translation and the original English version of this
-License, the original English version will prevail.
-
-
-9. TERMINATION
-
-You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Document except
-as expressly provided for under this License. Any other attempt to
-copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Document is void, and will
-automatically terminate your rights under this License. However,
-parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under this
-License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such
-parties remain in full compliance.
-
-
-10. FUTURE REVISIONS OF THIS LICENSE
-
-The Free Software Foundation may publish new, revised versions
-of the GNU Free Documentation License from time to time. Such new
-versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may
-differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. See
-http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/.
-
-Each version of the License is given a distinguishing version number.
-If the Document specifies that a particular numbered version of this
-License "or any later version" applies to it, you have the option of
-following the terms and conditions either of that specified version or
-of any later version that has been published (not as a draft) by the
-Free Software Foundation. If the Document does not specify a version
-number of this License, you may choose any version ever published (not
-as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation.
-
-
-ADDENDUM: How to use this License for your documents
-
-To use this License in a document you have written, include a copy of
-the License in the document and put the following copyright and
-license notices just after the title page:
-
- Copyright (c) YEAR YOUR NAME.
- Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
- under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1
- or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
- with the Invariant Sections being LIST THEIR TITLES, with the
- Front-Cover Texts being LIST, and with the Back-Cover Texts being LIST.
- A copy of the license is included in the section entitled "GNU
- Free Documentation License".
-
-If you have no Invariant Sections, write "with no Invariant Sections"
-instead of saying which ones are invariant. If you have no
-Front-Cover Texts, write "no Front-Cover Texts" instead of
-"Front-Cover Texts being LIST"; likewise for Back-Cover Texts.
-
-If your document contains nontrivial examples of program code, we
-recommend releasing these examples in parallel under your choice of
-free software license, such as the GNU General Public License,
-to permit their use in free software.
diff --git a/doc/Camel-Classes b/doc/Camel-Classes
deleted file mode 100644
index 93aec087dd..0000000000
--- a/doc/Camel-Classes
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,35 +0,0 @@
-CamelException
-CamelProvider
-CamelThreadProxy
-CamelURL
-GtkObject
- + CamelObject
- + CamelAddress
- | + CamelInternetAddress
- | ` CamelNewsAddress
- + CamelDataWrapper
- | + CamelMedium
- | | ` CamelMimePart
- | | ` CamelMimeMessage
- | ` CamelMultipart
- + CamelFolder
- | ` CamelFolderPtProxy
- + CamelFolderSearch
- + CamelFolderSummary
- + CamelMimeFilter
- | + CamelMimeFilterBasic
- | + CamelMimeFilterCharset
- | + CamelMimeFilterIndex
- | ` CamelMimeFilterSave
- + CamelService
- | + CamelStore
- | ` CamelTransport
- + CamelSession
- + CamelStream
- | + CamelSeekableStream
- | | + CamelSeekableSubstream
- | | + CamelStreamFs
- | | ` CamelStreamMem
- | + CamelStreamBuffer
- | ` CamelStreamFilter
- ` CamelThreadProxy \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/doc/ChangeLog b/doc/ChangeLog
deleted file mode 100644
index 3b2a5968d3..0000000000
--- a/doc/ChangeLog
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,587 +0,0 @@
-
-2000-11-01 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/config-prefs.sgml: Fixed validation errors.
-
- * C/apx-gloss.sgml: Fixed HTML, style stuff.
-
- * C/usage-mail.sgml: Stylistic overhaul.
-
- * C/usage-mainwindow.sgml: Fixed groups in shortcut bar, fixed
- folder navigation tips.
-
-2000-10-31 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/preface.sgml: Minor stylistic revisions.
-
-2000-10-30 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * COPYING-DOCS: New file. This is the official place to put the
- FDL now.
-
-
-2000-11-01 Radek Doulik <rodo@helixcode.com>
-
- * Keybindings: added composer keybindings description
-
-2000-10-25 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/menuref.sgml: Actions -> New Directory Server added.
-
- * C/config-prefs.sgml: Actions -> New Directory Server added.
-
- * C/usage-contact.sgml: Actions -> New Directory Server added.
-
- * C/menuref.sgml: Added mail Settings->Manage Subscriptions menu.
-
- * C/usage-mail.sgml: Subscriptions section added. Quite
- incomplete, though.
-
-2000-10-11 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/evolution-guide.sgml: Re-checked validity of all files. Made
- minor changes to menuref.sgml, usage-mail.sgml, usage-print.sgml to
- bring up to spec.
-
- * C/usage-mail.sgml: Redid Filter & Vfolder to match the new &
- improved functionality.
-
- * C/fig/*: Re-did remaining screenshots.
-
-2000-10-10 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/usage-print.sgml: New file, describing printing and print-preview.
-
- * C/fig/print-preview.png: New file.
-
- * C/fig/print-dest.png: New file.
-
- * C/evolution-guide.sgml: Added usage-print entity.
-
- * C/menuref.sgml: Fixed calendar menu stuff.
-
- * C/usage-mail.sgml: No more "Actions" menu, other assorted
- menu-related changes.
-
-2000-10-06 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/fig/ * replaced a whole bunch of screenshots.
-
-2000-10-05 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/usage-contact.sgml: Described Search features.
-
- * C/menuref.sgml: Contact Manager menus fixed.
-
-2000-10-04 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/usage-contact.sgml: Fixed glossterms.
-
- * C/usage-mail.sgml: Fixed glossterms, filenames, spellchecked.
-
- * C/apx-gloss.sgml: Added "Inline," "VCard".
-
- * C/usage-mainwindow.sgml: Fixed glossterms, filenames. Spellchecked.
-
- * C/usage-mail.sgml: Fixed glossterms, filenames. Spellchecked.
-
- * C/evolution-guide.sgml: New Legalnotice. Removed FDL and GPL,
- which are now included as part of the gnome-help package.
-
- * C/usage-contact.sgml: Spellcheck. Fixed some wording, and
- responded to clahey's suggestions-- notably, commented out the
- "add to master list" category feature.
-
- * C/usage-calendar.sgml: Spellcheck. Fixed wording, event overlap
- description.
-
- * C/evolution-guide.sgml: Spellcheck. Commented out Notes
- entities.
-
- * C/usage-notes.sgml: Spellchecked, then decided to comment out
- this file/chapter and all references to it, since it's unlikely to
- be implemented any time soon.
-
- * C/config-setupassist.sgml: Spellcheck. Other minor updates. May
- need more work in the near future.
-
- * C/usage-sync.sgml: Now it's really short. And spelled correctly.
-
-2000-10-03 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/config-prefs.sgml: Mostly spelling. Still needs major
- alteration.
-
- * C/menuref.sgml: s/Appintment/Appointment, fixed small errors,
- ran spellcheck. Still needs lots of work, since many menus have
- changed.
-
- * C/apx-gloss.sgml: Added Virus, Protocol, fixed vFolder,
- spellchecked.
-
-2000-09-26 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/apx-gloss.sgml: Added sendmail and SMTP.
-
-2000-09-22 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/menuref.sgml: Changed to reflect new menu layout.
-
- * C/usage-mainwindow.sgml: Changed to reflect new menu layout. Again.
-
- * C/usage-contact.sgml: Stop and Display All features.
-
-2000-09-21 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/evolution-guide.sgml: Switched to the "official" FSF markup.
- I will have to make changes to the markup-- adding ids, etc, or
- switch to another version of the markup. Pending discussion by
- GDP.
-
- * C/apx-authors.sgml: Changed Matt Loper's email address to
- loper.org; added Jeff Stedfast and Peter Williams to authors list,
- realphebetized.
-
- * C/config-prefs.sgml: Revision to reflect current options labelling.
-
- * C/evolution-guide.sgml: Changes to part intros.
-
- * C/preface.sgml: Spelling and menu fixes. Will need more work tomorrow.
-
-2000-09-20 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/config-prefs.sgml: Fixed sig stuff here and in setupassist.
-
- * C/config-sync.sgml: Fixed description of conduit usage.
-
-2000-09-18 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/preface.sgml: Spelling fixes, etc.
-
-=======
-2000-09-19 Federico Mena Quintero <federico@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/Makefile.am: Fixed to install the stylesheet-images as well.
-
->>>>>>> 1.26
-2000-09-07 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/fig/ New files: contact-editor.png, mail-composer.png,
- filter-assist-fig.png, mail-inbox.png
-
-2000-09-07 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/preface.sgml: Redid "soft" intro stuff.
-
- * C/evolution-guide.sgml: Accidentally broke docs, now valid.
-
-2000-09-06 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/usage-contact.sgml: Editing, proofing.
-
-2000-09-05 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/usage-contact.sgml: Grammar, links, screenshots.
-
- * fig/* Re-took most screenshots.
-
- * C/usage-mail.sgml: Filters, proofing.
-
-2000-09-01 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/config-prefs.sgml: Added coverage of news, clarified POP/IMAP
- distinction (there's a theme to these four log entries here).
-
- * C/usage-mail.sgml: Added coverage of news.
-
- * C/config-setupassist.sgml: Revised mail sources content for
- IMAP/POP stuff.
-
- * C/apx-gloss.sgml: Added IMAP and POP.
-
-2000-08-31 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/apx-gloss.sgml: Added regular expressions to glossary.
- Explanation should be removed from other portions of the book now.
-
- * C/usage-mainwindow.sgml: Revisions, minor.
-
- * C/apx-menuref.sgml: Now named menuref.sgml, to reflect its new
- status as a part.
-
- * C/evolution-guide.sgml: Structural alterations: Menuref is now a
- part, not an appendix.
-
- * C/apx-menuref.sgml: Added contextual menus for mail.
-
- * C/preface.sgml: Added "quickref and pointers" sections. Props to
- O'Reilly for the copy of Outlook in a Nutshell which gave me the
- idea.
-
-2000-08-30 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/usage-mainwindow.sgml: Minor fixes.
-
- * C/preface.sgml: Corrected grammar, added glossterms, described
- menuref.
-
-2000-08-25 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/usage-mail.sgml: Redid filter and vFolder assistant
- descriptions.
-
- * C/fig/filter-new-fig.png: Replaced with new assistant pic.
-
- * C/fig/filter-assist-fig.png: New file, showing only assistant.
-
-
- * C/apx-menuref.sgml: Finished message composer and calendar
- editor menus. Looked at Contact Editor menus and decided to
- document those features after implementation.
-
-2000-08-24 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/apx-menuref.sgml: Message Composer File and Edit menus.
-
-2000-08-23 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/apx-menuref.sgml: Added editor sections.
-
- * C/evolution-guide.sgml: Included Menu Reference Appendix.
-
-2000-08-22 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/usage-mail.sgml: Minor markup changes.
-
- * C/apx-menuref.sgml: New File. Menu Reference. Still needs much
- work, but not bad for an evening.
-
-2000-08-21 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/usage-mail.sgml: Kevin's diff applied, with minor changes.
-
-2000-08-09 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/evolution-guide.sgml: Fixed bugs in validation. Went home to
- sleep.
-
- * C/usage-mainwindow.sgml: Redid menubar description.
-
-
- * C/config-prefs.sgml: Added coverage of folder config, requested
- that feature be transferred to config section. Switched to
- variablelist in "Other" config section.
-
- * C/usage-mail.sgml: Added coverage of right-click on messages,
- threaded-view.
-
- * C/usage-mainwindow.sgml: Right-click on folder menu reinstated.
-
-2000-08-07 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/config-prefs.sgml: Added news server coverage. Other config
- proofing changes.
-
-
-2000-08-05 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/apx-gpl.sgml: New file. Contains contents of "COPYING",
- but marked up (probably not very well, but valid) as docbook
- (SGML).
-
- * C/evolution-guide.sgml: Subtle change to the legal notice:
- distinguished manual license from software license. Linked to
- apx-gpl.sgml above.
-
- * C/usage-calendar.sgml: I redid all the usage files.
-
-2000-07-21 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/usage-mail.sgml: Added password remembering/forgetting feature.
-
- * C/config-prefs.sgml: Mostly moved to variablelists, a few
- language changes.
-
- * C/config-setupassist.sgml: Minor changes to formatting, wording.
-
- * C/usage-notes.sgml: Changed trademark references, other minor
- changes.
-
- * C/usage-calendar.sgml: Minor fixes, added additional calendar
- section, removed references to unimplemented features. Spellcheck,
- prep for 0.3 release.
-
-2000-07-19 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/usage-mail.sgml: lots of minor fixes to language. added
- desc. of clahey's cool button-address thing.
-
- * C/usage-mainwindow.sgml: fixed itemizedlists, ch. to shortcut
- bar & folder descs, removed refs to trash.
-
-2000-07-18 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/usage-contact.sgml: Altered category addition stuff, plus
- suggestions from Kevin.
-
- * C/apx-gloss.sgml: Added ldap and signature definitions (from
- Kevin).
-
- * C/usage-mail.sgml: Move to variablelists from itemizedlists.
-
-2000-07-14 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/usage-contact.sgml: moved to variablelists from itemizedlists
- * C/usage-calendar.sgml: moved to variablelists from itemizedlists
-
-2000-06-29 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/preface.sgml: Minor fixes.
-
- * C/usage-notes.sgml: New File for feature that is yet to come.
- * C/evolution-guide.sgml: Added entity for notes chapter.
- * C/usage-mainwindow.sgml: Un-commented references to notes section.
-
- * C/apx-authors.sgml: Removed dcm from author list.
-
- * C/usage-calendar.sgml: Added to-do list features.
-
-2000-06-28 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/usage-contact.sgml: commented out future features; redid
- contact editor stuff.
-
- * C/apx-gloss.sgml: Removed "live doc" and added "minicard"
-
-2000-06-27 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/devel-action.sgml: Removed file.
- * C/devel-script.sgml: Same.
- * C/devel-component.sgml: Same.
- * C/preface.sgml: Removed references to devel section.
- * C/evolution-guide.sgml: Removed references to devel section.
-
-2000-06-23 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/evolution-guide.sgml: Made moderate to major stylistic updates
- to this, apx-gloss.sgml, and to all files beginning with "usage,"
- especially wrt HTML mail.
-
-
-2000-06-15 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/usage-contact.sgml: Category stuff improved.
-
- * C/usage-calendar.sgml: Now covers how to add an event properly.
-
-2000-07-17 Federico Mena Quintero <federico@helixcode.com>
-
- * Makefile.am (SUBDIRS): Added the devel directory.
-
-2000-06-28 Peter Williams <peterw@curious-george.helixcode.com>
-
- * C/Makefile.am (SGML_FILES): Don't depend on the newly-removed
- devel-*.sgml files.
-
-2000-06-16 Damon Chaplin <damon@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/.cvsignore: added evolution-guide and evolution-guide.junk
- so we don't get the '? doc/C/evolution-guide' messages each time we
- do a cvs update.
-
-2000-06-14 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/usage-mainwindow.sgml: added sect on menubar, other minor changes.
-
- * C/usage-mail.sgml: Improved filter and vfolder
- description, and some minor changes from me and Kevin.
-
-2000-06-07 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/config-prefs.sgml: finished adding calendar prefs. screenshots.
- * C/fig/config-cal.png: new file (screenshot for above)
- * C/fig/config-mail.png: same
-
-2000-06-05 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/usage-calendar.sgml: Incorporated chgs from Kevin.
-
- * C/config-prefs.sgml: began total overhaul of structure and added
- content reflecting new prefs items. needs LOTS more work.
-
- * C/usage-mail.sgml: changed some references to id's in the
- config-prefs section.
-
- * C/fig/config-mail.png: changed filename from config-prefs.png
-
-2000-06-01 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/config-prefs.sgml: filename was wrong, altered.
-
- * C/usage-mail.sgml: improved filter instructions, vFolder
- instructions. still need work though.
-
-
- * C/usage-contact.sgml: added screenshot.
-
- * C/usage-calendar.sgml: added screenshot.
-
- * C/config-prefs.sgml: added screenshots, and now describes the
- actual prefs dialogs.
-
- * C/fig/config-camel.png: new (screenshot) file
- * C/fig/filter-druid.png: same
- * C/fig/vfolder-druid.png: same
- * C/fig/calendar.png: same
- * C/fig/contact.png: same
- * C/fig/vfolder-createrule-fig.png: same
- * C/fig/filter-new-fig.png: same
- * C/fig/config-camel.png: same
-
-2000-06-01 Dan Winship <danw@helixcode.com>
-
- * Makefile.am: recurse into the C directory
-
- * C/Makefile.am: Rules to build and install the docs. Mostly
- stolen from gnomecal. Only works if you have GDP stuff
- (http://www.gnome.org/gdp/) set up on your machine, but won't make
- the build fail if you don't.
-
-2000-05-29 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/usage-contact.sgml: incorporated kevins notes.
- * C/usage-mainwindow.sgml: incorporated kevins notes.
-
-2000-05-27 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/evolution-guide.sgml: added Kevin Breit to author and
- copyright.
-
- * C/apx-authors.sgml: Put app authors in a simplelist.
-
- * C/usage-mail.sgml: Removed USAGE-SETUP insertion, added xref to send
- users to config-setupassist chapter. This and the following changes
- take setup druid coverage out of usage
- section and put it in config section.
- * C/config-setupassist.sgml: Added mail druid coverage from
- usage-setup.sgml.
- * C/usage-setup.sgml: Removed file. contents in
- config-setupassist.sgml.
- * C/evolution-guide.sgml: Removed
- USAGE-SETUP entity (and file usage-setup.sgml.)
-
-
-2000-05-26 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/fig/mainwindow-pic.png: new file
- * C/fig/mail-druid-pic.png: new file
- * C/fig: New directory, for figure graphics.
-
- * C/apx-gloss.sgml: new file. glossary. thx. to kevin from chicago.
-
- * C/usage-setup.sgml: More accurate description of druid, and
- moved to mail section-- see usage-mail.sgml entry. This is a new
- location for this entity, and it may move more later.
-
-
- * C/usage-mainwindow.sgml: altered description of starting
- evolution. added screenshot for main-window picture.
-
- * C/usage-mail.sgml: added screenshots, added coverage of setup
- druid and put it into get-and-send section, which is probably not
- where it should stay. Also started filter druid coverage and
- clarified examples, esp. in Bcc: section.
-
- * C/usage-contact.sgml: Clarified examples.
-
- * C/preface.sgml: rewording of "what is" and "about book" sections.
-
- * C/evolution-guide.sgml: added glossary entity APX-GLOSS, altered
- phrasing in part intros, changed order of Setup-assistant section.
-
- * C/config-prefs.sgml: changed wording, removed ref. to re-running
- setup assistant.
-
-2000-05-18 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/evo_book_0.1.sgml: removed.
-
- * C/apx-authors.sgml: new file.
- * C/apx-bugs.sgml: same.
- * C/apx-fdl.sgml: same.
- * C/config-prefs.sgml: same.
- * C/config-setupassist.sgml: same.
- * C/config-sync.sgml: same.
- * C/devel-action.sgml: same.
- * C/devel-component.sgml: same.
- * C/devel-script.sgml: same.
- * C/evolution-guide.sgml: same.
- * C/preface.sgml: same.
- * C/usage-calendar.sgml: same.
- * C/usage-contact.sgml: same.
- * C/usage-mail.sgml: same.
- * C/usage-mainwindow.sgml: same.
- * C/usage-setup.sgml: same.
- * C/usage-sync.sgml: same.
-
-2000-05-07 Dan Winship <danw@helixcode.com>
-
- * Camel-Classes: sync
-
-2000-04-16 Aaron Weber <aaron@helixcode.com>
-
- * C/evo_book_0.1.sgml: new file (doc sgml)
-
- * C/ : New directory for doc sgml & graphics
-
-2000-03-05 Christopher James Lahey <clahey@helixcode.com>
-
- * white-papers/widgets/e-table.sgml: Added Miguel to the author
- list for ETable.
-
-2000-03-03 Christopher James Lahey <clahey@helixcode.com>
-
- * white-papers/widgets/, white-papers/widgets/e-table.sgml: New
- doc for the ETable widget.
-
- * ChangeLog: Created a ChangeLog file for the docs file and
- integrated the individual ChangeLogs.
-
-2000-03-01 Dan Winship <danw@helixcode.com>
-
- * ibex.sgml: Ibex white paper
-
-2000-02-29 Federico Mena Quintero <federico@helixcode.com>
-
- * calendar.sgml: Sections for the calendar user agent and the
- calendar client library.
-
-2000-02-29 Dan Winship <danw@helixcode.com>
-
- * camel.sgml: Reorg a bit more, make the <PRE> section narrower,
- add more references to graphics (the graphics themselves are
- still in beta), add a section on CamelStream.
-
-2000-02-28 Federico Mena Quintero <federico@helixcode.com>
-
- * calendar.sgml: Section for the personal calendar server.
-
-2000-02-28 Dan Winship <danw@helixcode.com>
-
- * camel.sgml: add Bertrand to authors, edit his additions
-
-2000-02-28 bertrand <bertrand@helixcode.com>
-
- * camel.sgml: add a blurb about camel offering
- uniform interface. needs style and grammar corrections.
- Talk about virtual folders.
- Talk about lightweight messages
- Talk about IMAP.
-
-2000-02-28 Dan Winship <danw@helixcode.com>
-
- * camel.sgml: Beginnings of a Camel white paper
-
-2000-02-25 Federico Mena Quintero <federico@helixcode.com>
-
- * calendar.sgml: New file for the Evolution calendaring white paper.
diff --git a/doc/Design b/doc/Design
deleted file mode 100644
index 7b7cf6f821..0000000000
--- a/doc/Design
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,201 +0,0 @@
-
-The Evolution Project specification
-Miguel de Icaza.
-
-
-* Introduction
-
- Evolution is a project aiming at providing the free software
- community with a professional, high-quality tool for managing
- mail, appointments, tasks and other personal information
- tools.
-
- We want to make Evolution a system that addresses our needs
- (the free software development community) and we believe that
- by addressing our needs, we will provide a system that will
- scale in the years to come for other users that are just
- starting to use computers and the internet.
-
- The main objectives of Evolution are to provide these powerful
- features, and to make the user interface as pretty and
- polished as possible.
-
- Evolution is a GNOME application and a number of auxiliary
- CORBA servers that act as the storage backends.
-
- Evolution will copy the best user interface bits and the best
- ideas and features found on contemporary groupware systems.
-
-* Evolution internals.
-
- Evolution can store its information locally (files for mail,
- calendar and address book) or on a remote server (imap/pop,
- cap, ldap).
-
- Given the importance of syncing in this modern PDA world,
- the Evolution GUI acts as a client to the data repository.
- The data repository is a GUI-less CORBA server called Wombat.
-
- Wombat provides a unified access system to the calendar and
- addressbook data (doing mail is a bit hard, so we are leaving
- this as a TODO item for now).
-
- Wombat's CORBA interfaces are notifier-based. This means that
- CORBA requests sent to Wombat do not return values
- inmediately, but rather than for Wombat requests the user has
- to provide a CORBA object that will be notified of what
- happened.
-
- Yes, that sounds hairy. It is actually pretty simple. It
- basically means that you submit requests to Wombat, and a
- callback is invoked in your code when the request has been
- carried away.
-
- This enables a Palm to sync to the repository without having
- the GUI for Evolution running. It also means that volunteers
- will be able to write text-based and web-based versions of
- Evolution (not me though :-).
-
-* Evolution as a platform
-
- Evolution is more than a client for managing the above
- information: Evolution is a platform for building groupware
- applications that use the above components to get their work done.
-
- To achieve this Evolution is designed to be scriptable, and it
- exports its internals trough CORBA/Bonobo. It is implemented
- as a collection of Bonobo containers and Bonobo components.
-
- There is a clean separation between the views (the user
- interface) and the model (the view). The views that we are
- writing are GNOME based, and they talk to the Wombat CORBA
- server.
-
- Wombat takes care of notifications to the various clients for
- the data.
-
-* The overall organization
-
- A bar similar to outlook provides shortcuts for accessing the
- various resources managed by Evolution: mail folders,
- contacts, tasks, journal entries, notes, messages and other
- user-defined destinations.
-
-* User interface widgets
-
-** The ETable package
-
- This package provides a way of displaying and editing tables.
-
- Tables are displayed based on a TableColumn definition that
- defines the layout used for the display. Table Columns can be
- nested, and the package does grouping of information displayed
- according to the criteria defined there.
-
- This is used in multiple places troughout evolution: it is
- used for the Mail summary display, for the TODO display and
- TODO new data entry and for the address book.
-
- Nesting in the address book can be performed on various
- fields. For example, a first level of nesting could be
- "Company" and a second level would be "Country" the result is
- a 2-level tree that can be collapsed expanded and contains the
- information sorted/grouped by those two criteria.
-
- The user interface for this will be copied from Outlook: the
- possibility of adding and removing fields with drag and drop
- as well as grouping using drag and drop.
-
-* The Mail system
-
-** The Mail sources
-
- The mail system will support 4 sources of mail:
-
- POP3 (transfer to a local file).
- IMAP
- Local mbox format in $MAIL.
- Local mbox format that have other delivery points.
-
- On top of that, it will be possible to browse existing mbox
- archives (and possibly other formats in the future, like
- Mailbox and Maildir).
-
-** Storing the mail
-
- Mail that gets incorporated into the system is stored in mbox
- format, and summary files are provided for quick access to the
- files. No modifications to the file on disk is performed (I
- am not quite sure about this, perhaps we want to add the
- status flags and some method for adding metadata to the mail).
-
- Summary files are rebuilt on demand or rebuild if the mbox
- file and the summary file have got out of sync.
-
- A Metadata system that will enable us to attach information to
- a message will have to be designed and implemented (enabling
- users to add annotations to mails, and special keywords and
- flags in a per-message fashion).
-
-** Folders
-
- Michael Zucchi is working on a system that will let users
- easily define rules for splitting their incoming mail into
- physical folders.
-
- A further refinement to Folders are Virtual Folders. This
- basically provides a powerful search and viewing facility for
- mail. It works like this: when a mail is "incorporated" into
- Evolution it is scanned and indexed.
-
- Then users can enter queries into Evolution that will search
- the entire database of messages.
-
-** Virtual folders
-
- Virtual folders will enable users to read/browse their mail in
- new ways: by specifying search criterias, these folders will
- contain messages that match the criteria given.
-
- There is more information about this in the libcamel
- directory.
-
- We will index all headers from a message, and possible the
- contents of messages and keep those on a separate file, to
- enable users to query their mail database.
-
-** Mail summary display
-
- The summary will be displayed using the ETable package, to
- enable users to add a number of sorting criteria and various
- display methods for the summary view.
-
- The Outlook methods for displaying will be present on the
- system.
-
- Message threading will be supported in Evolution.
-
-** Message display engine
-
- We are going to be using a combination of
- libcamel/limime/libjamie to parse messages and render them
- into an HTML buffer.
-
-* The HTML engine
-
- The GtkHTML engine will be used to display messages, and will
- be extended to support a number of features that we require:
- internal handling of characters will be based on Unicode
-
-* The message composer
-
- Regular features found in composers will be added: connecting
- the composer to the address book, support for drag and drop
- for including attachments, editing the message, archiving
- drafts and archiving messages sent.
-
- Ettore has been working on adding editing support to the
- GtkHTML and he is working currently on a Bonobo component that
- will provide a ready-to-use Bonobo control for embedding into
- other applications.
-
diff --git a/doc/Keybindings b/doc/Keybindings
deleted file mode 100644
index f232802110..0000000000
--- a/doc/Keybindings
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,13 +0,0 @@
-* Keybindings for the mailer
-
- Delete key: Deletes message, moves forward.
-
-* Keybindings for the composer
-
- Control-s: Saves message to file.
- Control-w: Closes composer window.
- Control-Return: Sends message now.
-
- F6: Opens find dialog.
- F7: Opens replace dialog.
-
diff --git a/doc/Makefile.am b/doc/Makefile.am
deleted file mode 100644
index 7b5420fee8..0000000000
--- a/doc/Makefile.am
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1 +0,0 @@
-SUBDIRS = C devel
diff --git a/doc/devel/.cvsignore b/doc/devel/.cvsignore
deleted file mode 100644
index c24a54fbcc..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/.cvsignore
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,4 +0,0 @@
-Makefile
-Makefile.in
-html
-evolution-devel-guide.html
diff --git a/doc/devel/ChangeLog b/doc/devel/ChangeLog
deleted file mode 100644
index 555db7d161..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/ChangeLog
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,40 +0,0 @@
-2000-09-15 Federico Mena Quintero <federico@helixcode.com>
-
- * evolution-devel-guide.sgml: Made the toplevel <book> id be
- "index".
-
-2000-08-14 Federico Mena Quintero <federico@helixcode.com>
-
- * calendar/cal-util/*: Integrated the cal-util library into the
- documentation framework.
-
- * calendar/Makefile.am (SUBDIRS): Added the cal-util directory.
-
- * evolution-devel-guide.sgml: Added entities for the cal-util stuff.
- Added entity for libical.
-
- * calendar/reference.sgml: Added the cal-util reference entries.
-
- * calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client-sections.txt: Updated
- for new API.
-
-2000-08-09 Peter Williams <peterw@helixcode.com>
-
- * Makefile.am (maintainer-clean-local): Don't depend
- on 'clean'; this messes up maintainer-clean.
-
-2000-07-17 Federico Mena Quintero <federico@helixcode.com>
-
- * calendar/cal-client/tmpl/cal-client.sgml: Populated.
-
- * evolution-devel-guide.sgml: New <book> toplevel for the
- Evolution Developer's Guide.
-
- * calendar/evolution-calendar.sgml: New <part> for the calendar
- developer's documentation.
-
- * calendar/architecture.sgml: New <chapter> for the calendar
- architecture.
-
- * calendar/reference.sgml: New <reference> for the calendar API
- reference.
diff --git a/doc/devel/Makefile.am b/doc/devel/Makefile.am
deleted file mode 100644
index 0d3cec5a1c..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/Makefile.am
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,64 +0,0 @@
-SUBDIRS = calendar
-
-# The name of the module.
-DOC_MODULE=evolution-devel-guide
-
-# The top-level SGML file.
-DOC_MAIN_SGML_FILE=evolution-devel-guide.sgml
-
-HTML_DIR=$(datadir)/gnome/html
-
-TARGET_DIR=$(HTML_DIR)/$(DOC_MODULE)
-
-evolution_devel_guidedir = $(HTML_DIR)
-evolution_devel_guide_DATA = \
- evolution-devel-guide.html
-
-content_files = \
- evolution-devel-guide.sgml
-
-EXTRA_DIST = \
- $(evolution_devel_guide_DATA) \
- $(content_files)
-
-if ENABLE_GTK_DOC
-evolution-devel-guide.html: html/book1.html
- -cd $(srcdir) && cp html/book1.html evolution-devel-guide.html
-else
-evolution-devel-guide.html:
-endif
-
-html/book1.html: $(content-files)
- $(MAKE) html
-
-html:
- test -d $(srcdir)/html || mkdir $(srcdir)/html
- -cd $(srcdir)/html && gtkdoc-mkhtml $(DOC_MODULE) ../$(DOC_MAIN_SGML_FILE)
-
-clean-local:
- rm -f *~ *.bak *.signals *-unused.txt
-
-maintainer-clean-local:
- cd $(srcdir) && rm -rf html
-
-install-data-local:
- $(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(TARGET_DIR)
- (installfiles=`echo $(srcdir)/html/*.html`; \
- if test "$$installfiles" = '$(srcdir)/html/*.html'; \
- then echo '-- Nothing to install' ; \
- else \
- for i in $$installfiles; do \
- echo '-- Installing '$$i ; \
- $(INSTALL_DATA) $$i $(DESTDIR)$(TARGET_DIR); \
- done; \
- echo '-- Installing $(srcdir)/html/index.sgml' ; \
- $(INSTALL_DATA) $(srcdir)/html/index.sgml $(DESTDIR)$(TARGET_DIR); \
- echo '-- Fixing Crossreferences' ; \
- gtkdoc-fixxref --module=$(DOC_MODULE) --html-dir=$(HTML_DIR)|| true; \
- fi)
-
-dist-hook:
- mkdir $(distdir)/html
- -cp $(srcdir)/html/*.html $(srcdir)/html/*.css $(distdir)/html
-
-.PHONY: html
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/.cvsignore b/doc/devel/calendar/.cvsignore
deleted file mode 100644
index 282522db03..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/.cvsignore
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,2 +0,0 @@
-Makefile
-Makefile.in
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/Makefile.am b/doc/devel/calendar/Makefile.am
deleted file mode 100644
index 2220e1d59b..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/Makefile.am
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,6 +0,0 @@
-SUBDIRS = cal-client cal-util
-
-EXTRA_DIST = \
- architecture.sgml \
- evolution-calendar.sgml \
- reference.sgml
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/architecture.sgml b/doc/devel/calendar/architecture.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index 08e4c82b35..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/architecture.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,94 +0,0 @@
- <chapter id="calendar-architecture">
- <title>Architecture of the Calendar</title>
-
- <para>
- This chapter gives an overview of the Evolution Calendar
- architecture. It describes the model/view split of the calendar
- into a personal calendar server, or PCS, and the GUI clients
- that appear inside the Evolution shell.
- </para>
-
- <!-- Model/View Separation -->
-
- <sect1 id="calendar-model-view">
- <title>Model/View Separation</title>
-
- <para>
- Like other base components in Evolution, the calendar
- separates the data model from the views or clients. This is
- done so that multiple clients can access the same calendar
- data in an orderly fashion and without clashes. For example,
- the user may be running a graphical calendar client. If he
- then wants to synchronize his calendar with a handheld device,
- then the corresponding synchronization program (e.g. a conduit
- for the <application>gnome-pilot</application> package) will
- also need to access the calendar storage. It is important
- that both the GUI client and the synchronization program keep
- a consistent view of the calendar at all times, otherwise one
- of them will be left in an inconsistent state if the
- calendar's data changes unexpectedly.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Evolution puts the calendar storage in a daemon called the
- Wombat and completely separates it from clients who wants to
- access calendar data. This part of the Wombat is called the
- personal calendar server, or &PCS;. Clients must contact the
- &PCS; and ask it to open an existing calendar or create a new
- one. When a calendar component object (e.g. an appointment or
- to-do item) changes in the &PCS; it will notify all the
- clients that are using the component's parent calendar.
- </para>
- </sect1>
-
- <!-- Personal Calendar Server -->
-
- <sect1>
- <title>Personal Calendar Server</title>
-
- <para>
- The personal calendar server, or &PCS;, provides centralized
- management and storage of a user's personal calendar.
- Multiple clients can connect to the &PCS; simultaneously to
- query and modify the user's calendar in a synchronized
- fashion. The main features of the &PCS; are as follows:
- </para>
-
- <formalpara>
- <title>Storage</title>
-
- <para>
- The &PCS; is responsible for loading and saving calendars.
- Centralizing the loading and saving functionality allows
- multiple clients to use the same calendar at the same time
- without having to worry about each other.
- </para>
- </formalpara>
-
- <formalpara>
- <title>Basic Queries</title>
-
- <para>
- The &PCS; provides functions to do basic queries on a
- calendar, for example, a client can ask the server for a
- list of all the appointments in the calendar, or for all the
- data for a specific appointment.
- </para>
- </formalpara>
-
- <formalpara>
- <title>Recurrence and Alarm Queries</title>
-
- <para>
-
- </para>
- </formalpara>
- </sect1>
- </chapter>
-
-<!--
-Local variables:
-mode: sgml
-sgml-parent-document: ("../evolution-devel-guide.sgml" "book" "part" "")
-End:
--->
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/.cvsignore b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/.cvsignore
deleted file mode 100644
index 0842a93f7a..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/.cvsignore
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,3 +0,0 @@
-sgml
-Makefile
-Makefile.in
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/Makefile.am b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/Makefile.am
deleted file mode 100644
index 44d43639a8..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/Makefile.am
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,76 +0,0 @@
-## Process this file with automake to produce Makefile.in
-
-# The name of the module.
-DOC_MODULE=evolution-cal-client
-
-# The top-level SGML file.
-DOC_MAIN_SGML_FILE=evolution-cal-client.sgml
-
-# The directory containing the source code (if it contains documentation).
-DOC_SOURCE_DIR=$(EVOLUTION_DIR)/calendar/cal-client
-
-CFLAGS =" \
- -I$(top_srcdir)/calendar \
- -I$(top_srcdir) \
- -I$(top_builddir) \
- -I$(top_builddir)/libical/src/libical \
- -I$(top_srcdir)/libical/src/libical \
- $(BONOBO_VFS_GNOME_CFLAGS) \
- "
-
-LDFLAGS=" \
- $(BONOBO_VFS_GNOME_LIBS) \
- $(top_builddir)/calendar/cal-client/.libs/libcal-client.a \
- $(top_builddir)/calendar/cal-util/.libs/libcal-util.a \
- $(top_builddir)/libical/src/libical/libical.a \
- $(top_builddir)/libversit/.libs/libversit.al \
- "
-
-HTML_DIR=$(datadir)/gnome/html
-
-TARGET_DIR=$(HTML_DIR)/$(DOC_MODULE)
-
-tmpl_sources = \
- tmpl/cal-client.sgml \
- tmpl/evolution-cal-client-unused.sgml
-
-evolution_cal_client_docdir = $(HTML_DIR)
-evolution_cal_client_doc_DATA = \
- evolution-cal-client.hierarchy \
- evolution-cal-client.types \
- evolution-cal-client-decl.txt \
- evolution-cal-client-sections.txt
-
-EXTRA_DIST = \
- $(evolution_cal_client_doc_DATA)
-
-sgml/evolution-cal-client-doc.bottom: $(tmpl_sources)
- $(MAKE) sgml
-
-scan:
- -(cd $(srcdir) \
- && env CFLAGS=$(CFLAGS) LDFLAGS=$(LDFLAGS) \
- gtkdoc-scanobj --module=$(DOC_MODULE) \
- && gtkdoc-scan --module=$(DOC_MODULE) --source-dir=$(DOC_SOURCE_DIR) --ignore-headers="cal-listener.h evolution-calendar.h" )
-
-templates: scan
- cd $(srcdir) && gtkdoc-mktmpl --module=$(DOC_MODULE)
-
-sgml:
- cd $(srcdir) \
- && gtkdoc-mkdb --module=$(DOC_MODULE) --source-dir=$(DOC_SOURCE_DIR)
-
-clean-local:
- rm -f *~ *.bak *.signals *-unused.txt
-
-maintainer-clean-local: clean
- cd $(srcdir) && rm -rf sgml $(DOC_MODULE)-decl-list.txt $(DOC_MODULE)-decl.txt
-
-dist-hook:
- mkdir $(distdir)/sgml
- mkdir $(distdir)/tmpl
- -cp $(srcdir)/tmpl/*.sgml $(distdir)/tmpl
- -cp $(srcdir)/sgml/*.sgml $(distdir)/sgml
- -cp $(srcdir)/sgml/*.bottom $(srcdir)/sgml/*.top $(distdir)/sgml
-
-.PHONY : sgml templates scan
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client-decl.txt b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client-decl.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index 0574d70678..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client-decl.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,132 +0,0 @@
-<MACRO>
-<NAME>CAL_CLIENT_TYPE</NAME>
-#define CAL_CLIENT_TYPE (cal_client_get_type ())
-</MACRO>
-<MACRO>
-<NAME>CAL_CLIENT</NAME>
-#define CAL_CLIENT(obj) (GTK_CHECK_CAST ((obj), CAL_CLIENT_TYPE, CalClient))
-</MACRO>
-<MACRO>
-<NAME>CAL_CLIENT_CLASS</NAME>
-#define CAL_CLIENT_CLASS(klass) (GTK_CHECK_CLASS_CAST ((klass), CAL_CLIENT_TYPE, CalClientClass))
-</MACRO>
-<MACRO>
-<NAME>IS_CAL_CLIENT</NAME>
-#define IS_CAL_CLIENT(obj) (GTK_CHECK_TYPE ((obj), CAL_CLIENT_TYPE))
-</MACRO>
-<MACRO>
-<NAME>IS_CAL_CLIENT_CLASS</NAME>
-#define IS_CAL_CLIENT_CLASS(klass) (GTK_CHECK_CLASS_TYPE ((klass), CAL_CLIENT_TYPE))
-</MACRO>
-<STRUCT>
-<NAME>CalClient</NAME>
-</STRUCT>
-<STRUCT>
-<NAME>CalClientClass</NAME>
-</STRUCT>
-<ENUM>
-<NAME>CalClientLoadStatus</NAME>
-typedef enum {
- CAL_CLIENT_LOAD_SUCCESS,
- CAL_CLIENT_LOAD_ERROR,
- CAL_CLIENT_LOAD_IN_USE,
- CAL_CLIENT_LOAD_METHOD_NOT_SUPPORTED
-} CalClientLoadStatus;
-</ENUM>
-<ENUM>
-<NAME>CalClientGetStatus</NAME>
-typedef enum {
- CAL_CLIENT_GET_SUCCESS,
- CAL_CLIENT_GET_NOT_FOUND,
- CAL_CLIENT_GET_SYNTAX_ERROR
-} CalClientGetStatus;
-</ENUM>
-<STRUCT>
-<NAME>CalClient</NAME>
-struct CalClient {
- GtkObject object;
-
- /* Private data */
- gpointer priv;
-};
-</STRUCT>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_client_get_type</NAME>
-<RETURNS>GtkType </RETURNS>
-void
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_client_construct</NAME>
-<RETURNS>CalClient *</RETURNS>
-CalClient *client
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_client_new</NAME>
-<RETURNS>CalClient *</RETURNS>
-void
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_client_load_calendar</NAME>
-<RETURNS>gboolean </RETURNS>
-CalClient *client, const char *str_uri
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_client_create_calendar</NAME>
-<RETURNS>gboolean </RETURNS>
-CalClient *client, const char *str_uri
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_client_get_n_objects</NAME>
-<RETURNS>int </RETURNS>
-CalClient *client, CalObjType type
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_client_get_object</NAME>
-<RETURNS>CalClientGetStatus </RETURNS>
-CalClient *client,const char *uid,CalComponent **comp
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_client_get_uid_by_pilot_id</NAME>
-<RETURNS>CalClientGetStatus </RETURNS>
-CalClient *client,unsigned long pilot_id,char **uid
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_client_update_pilot_id</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalClient *client, char *uid,unsigned long pilot_id,unsigned long pilot_status
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_client_get_uids</NAME>
-<RETURNS>GList *</RETURNS>
-CalClient *client, CalObjType type
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_client_get_objects_in_range</NAME>
-<RETURNS>GList *</RETURNS>
-CalClient *client, CalObjType type,time_t start, time_t end
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_client_generate_instances</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalClient *client, CalObjType type,time_t start, time_t end,CalRecurInstanceFn cb, gpointer cb_data
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_client_get_alarms_in_range</NAME>
-<RETURNS>GList *</RETURNS>
-CalClient *client, time_t start, time_t end
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_client_get_alarms_for_object</NAME>
-<RETURNS>gboolean </RETURNS>
-CalClient *client, const char *uid,time_t start, time_t end,GList **alarms
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_client_update_object</NAME>
-<RETURNS>gboolean </RETURNS>
-CalClient *client, CalComponent *comp
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_client_remove_object</NAME>
-<RETURNS>gboolean </RETURNS>
-CalClient *client, const char *uid
-</FUNCTION>
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client-sections.txt b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client-sections.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index c37b223247..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client-sections.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,37 +0,0 @@
-<INCLUDE>cal-client/cal-client.h</INCLUDE>
-
-<SECTION>
-<FILE>cal-client</FILE>
-CAL_CLIENT
-<TITLE>CalClient</TITLE>
-
-CalClientLoadStatus
-CalClientGetStatus
-cal_client_new
-cal_client_load_calendar
-cal_client_create_calendar
-cal_client_get_n_objects
-cal_client_get_object
-cal_client_get_objects_in_range
-cal_client_generate_instances
-cal_client_get_uid_by_pilot_id
-cal_client_update_pilot_id
-cal_client_get_uids
-cal_client_get_alarms_in_range
-cal_client_get_alarms_for_object
-cal_client_update_object
-cal_client_remove_object
-
-<SUBSECTION Standard>
-
-CAL_CLIENT_TYPE
-IS_CAL_CLIENT
-CAL_CLIENT_CLASS
-IS_CAL_CLIENT_CLASS
-cal_client_get_type
-cal_client_construct
-
-<SUBSECTION Private>
-CalClient
-
-</SECTION>
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client.args b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client.args
deleted file mode 100644
index e69de29bb2..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client.args
+++ /dev/null
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client.hierarchy b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client.hierarchy
deleted file mode 100644
index 88efa3e673..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client.hierarchy
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,2 +0,0 @@
-GtkObject
- CalClient
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client.signals b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client.signals
deleted file mode 100644
index 97e360b6a2..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client.signals
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,21 +0,0 @@
-<SIGNAL>
-<NAME>CalClient::cal-loaded</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void</RETURNS>
-CalClient *calclient
-GtkEnum arg1
-</SIGNAL>
-
-<SIGNAL>
-<NAME>CalClient::obj-updated</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void</RETURNS>
-CalClient *calclient
-GtkString arg1
-</SIGNAL>
-
-<SIGNAL>
-<NAME>CalClient::obj-removed</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void</RETURNS>
-CalClient *calclient
-GtkString arg1
-</SIGNAL>
-
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client.types b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client.types
deleted file mode 100644
index 84d65a6637..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/evolution-cal-client.types
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,4 +0,0 @@
-#include <gnome.h>
-#include <cal-client/cal-client.h>
-
-cal_client_get_type
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/tmpl/cal-client.sgml b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/tmpl/cal-client.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index 06469ff3ee..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/tmpl/cal-client.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,294 +0,0 @@
-<!-- ##### SECTION Title ##### -->
-CalClient
-
-<!-- ##### SECTION Short_Description ##### -->
-GTK+ object for communication with personal calendar server.
-
-<!-- ##### SECTION Long_Description ##### -->
- <para>
- The #CalClient object provides a nice GTK+ wrapper for the CORBA
- interfaces that are used to communicate between calendar clients
- and the personal calendar server in the user's Wombat daemon. The
- CORBA interfaces transfer calendar components in RFC 2445 text
- format; the #CalClient object automatically converts these into
- #CalComponent structures that are easier to handle.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- After a #CalClient object is created with cal_client_new(), it
- should be asked to send a request to the personal calendar server
- to load or create a calendar based on its URI. The server will
- asynchronously notify the client about completion of the request,
- and will return an appropriate result code; this should be noted
- by the client with the <link
- linkend="CalClient--cal-loaded">cal_loaded</link> signal.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- When a client asks the server to update or delete a calendar
- component from the storage, the server will do so and then notify
- all the clients about the update or removal. This is the core of
- the model/view split between calendar clients and the storage in
- the personal calendar server. Clients should watch the <link
- linkend="calclient-obj-updated">obj_updated</link> and <link
- linkend="calclient-obj-removed">obj_removed</link> signals on the
- CalClient objects they create so that they can be notified about
- changes in the storage.
- </para>
-
-<!-- ##### SECTION See_Also ##### -->
- <para>
- #CalComponent
- </para>
-
-<!-- ##### MACRO CAL_CLIENT ##### -->
- <para>
- Casts a #GtkObject to a #CalClient.
- </para>
-
-@obj: A GTK+ object.
-
-
-<!-- ##### ENUM CalClientLoadStatus ##### -->
- <para>
- These values describe the status of a calendar load or create
- request. After asking a calendar factory to load or create a
- calendar, the provided listener will get notification about the
- result in asynchronous fashion. Such notification is represented
- by one of these enumeration values. For values other than
- #CAL_CLIENT_LOAD_SUCCESS, the #CalClient object will not accept
- any other operations on the calendar and it should just be
- destroyed.
- </para>
-
-@CAL_CLIENT_LOAD_SUCCESS: Indicates a successful load or create
- operation; the corresponding calendar is ready for use.
-@CAL_CLIENT_LOAD_ERROR: Indicates an error while loading or creating
- the calendar.
-@CAL_CLIENT_LOAD_IN_USE: Indicates that a create request failed
- because the specified calendar was already being used by another
- client.
-@CAL_CLIENT_LOAD_METHOD_NOT_SUPPORTED: Indicates an error due to
- trying to load a calendar for which a backend type is not present.
-
-<!-- ##### ENUM CalClientGetStatus ##### -->
- <para>
- These values describe the result of the cal_client_get_object()
- function.
- </para>
-
-@CAL_CLIENT_GET_SUCCESS: Indicates a successful get operation.
-@CAL_CLIENT_GET_NOT_FOUND: Indicates that the requested object was
- not found.
-@CAL_CLIENT_GET_SYNTAX_ERROR: Indicates a syntax error when parsing
- the requested object. This could indicate a bug in the calendar
- client libraries or in the Wombat server.
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_client_new ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_client_load_calendar ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@client:
-@str_uri:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_client_create_calendar ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@client:
-@str_uri:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_client_get_n_objects ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@client:
-@type:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_client_get_object ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@client:
-@uid:
-@comp:
-@Returns:
-<!-- # Unused Parameters # -->
-@ico:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_client_get_objects_in_range ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@client:
-@type:
-@start:
-@end:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_client_generate_instances ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@client:
-@type:
-@start:
-@end:
-@cb:
-@cb_data:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_client_get_uid_by_pilot_id ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@client:
-@pilot_id:
-@uid:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_client_update_pilot_id ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@client:
-@uid:
-@pilot_id:
-@pilot_status:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_client_get_uids ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@client:
-@type:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_client_get_alarms_in_range ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@client:
-@start:
-@end:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_client_get_alarms_for_object ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@client:
-@uid:
-@start:
-@end:
-@alarms:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_client_update_object ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@client:
-@comp:
-@Returns:
-<!-- # Unused Parameters # -->
-@ico:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_client_remove_object ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@client:
-@uid:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### SIGNAL CalClient::cal-loaded ##### -->
- <para>
- This signal is emitted some time after the calendar clients sends
- a load or create request to the personal calendar server. The
- server will notify the client asynchronously of the completion of
- the request. The @status parameter indicates the status of the
- request.
- </para>
-
-@calclient: the object which received the signal.
-@arg1:
-<!-- # Unused Parameters # -->
-@client: Calendar client which received the notification.
-@status: Status of the request. See the description of
- #CalClientLoadStatus for more details.
-
-<!-- ##### SIGNAL CalClient::obj-updated ##### -->
- <para>
- This signal is emitted when the calendar clients receives
- notification of a calendar component's data being changed in the
- personal calendar server. Graphical clients may want to get the
- new version of the object and update their display, for example.
- </para>
-
-@calclient: the object which received the signal.
-@arg1:
-<!-- # Unused Parameters # -->
-@client: Calendar client which received the notification.
-@uid: Unique identifier of the calendar component that changed in the
- personal calendar server's storage.
-
-<!-- ##### SIGNAL CalClient::obj-removed ##### -->
- <para>
- This signal is emitted when the calendar client receives
- notification for a calendar component being removed from the
- storage in the personal calendar server. Graphical clients may
- want to delete the corresponding object from their display, for
- example.
- </para>
-
-@calclient: the object which received the signal.
-@arg1:
-<!-- # Unused Parameters # -->
-@client: Calendar client which received the notification.
-@uid: Unique identifier of the calendar component that was removed
- from the personal calendar server's storage.
-
-<!--
-Local variables:
-mode: sgml
-sgml-parent-document: ("../../../evolution-devel-guide.sgml" "book" "refsect2" "")
-End:
--->
-
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/tmpl/evolution-cal-client-unused.sgml b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/tmpl/evolution-cal-client-unused.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index 5576dbd57f..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-client/tmpl/evolution-cal-client-unused.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,10 +0,0 @@
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_client_get_events_in_range ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@client:
-@start:
-@end:
-@Returns:
-
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/.cvsignore b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/.cvsignore
deleted file mode 100644
index 0842a93f7a..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/.cvsignore
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,3 +0,0 @@
-sgml
-Makefile
-Makefile.in
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/Makefile.am b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/Makefile.am
deleted file mode 100644
index 8861aa03cb..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/Makefile.am
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,75 +0,0 @@
-## Process this file with automake to produce Makefile.in
-
-# The name of the module.
-DOC_MODULE=evolution-cal-util
-
-# The top-level SGML file.
-DOC_MAIN_SGML_FILE=evolution-cal-util.sgml
-
-# The directory containing the source code (if it contains documentation).
-DOC_SOURCE_DIR=$(EVOLUTION_DIR)/calendar/cal-util
-
-CFLAGS =" \
- -I$(top_srcdir)/calendar \
- -I$(top_srcdir) \
- -I$(top_builddir) \
- -I$(top_builddir)/libical/src/libical \
- -I$(top_srcdir)/libical/src/libical \
- $(BONOBO_VFS_GNOME_CFLAGS) \
- "
-
-LDFLAGS=" \
- $(BONOBO_VFS_GNOME_LIBS) \
- $(top_builddir)/calendar/cal-util/.libs/libcal-util.a \
- $(top_builddir)/libical/src/libical/libical.a \
- $(top_builddir)/libversit/.libs/libversit.al \
- "
-
-HTML_DIR=$(datadir)/gnome/html
-
-TARGET_DIR=$(HTML_DIR)/$(DOC_MODULE)
-
-tmpl_sources = \
- tmpl/cal-util.sgml \
- tmpl/evolution-cal-util-unused.sgml
-
-evolution_cal_util_docdir = $(HTML_DIR)
-evolution_cal_util_doc_DATA = \
- evolution-cal-util.hierarchy \
- evolution-cal-util.types \
- evolution-cal-util-decl.txt \
- evolution-cal-util-sections.txt
-
-EXTRA_DIST = \
- $(evolution_cal_util_doc_DATA)
-
-sgml/evolution-cal-util-doc.bottom: $(tmpl_sources)
- $(MAKE) sgml
-
-scan:
- -(cd $(srcdir) \
- && env CFLAGS=$(CFLAGS) LDFLAGS=$(LDFLAGS) \
- gtkdoc-scanobj --module=$(DOC_MODULE) \
- && gtkdoc-scan --module=$(DOC_MODULE) --source-dir=$(DOC_SOURCE_DIR) --ignore-headers="calobj.h icalendar-save.h icalendar.h" )
-
-templates: scan
- cd $(srcdir) && gtkdoc-mktmpl --module=$(DOC_MODULE)
-
-sgml:
- cd $(srcdir) \
- && gtkdoc-mkdb --module=$(DOC_MODULE) --source-dir=$(DOC_SOURCE_DIR)
-
-clean-local:
- rm -f *~ *.bak *.signals *-unused.txt
-
-maintainer-clean-local: clean
- cd $(srcdir) && rm -rf sgml $(DOC_MODULE)-decl-list.txt $(DOC_MODULE)-decl.txt
-
-dist-hook:
- mkdir $(distdir)/sgml
- mkdir $(distdir)/tmpl
- -cp $(srcdir)/tmpl/*.sgml $(distdir)/tmpl
- -cp $(srcdir)/sgml/*.sgml $(distdir)/sgml
- -cp $(srcdir)/sgml/*.bottom $(srcdir)/sgml/*.top $(distdir)/sgml
-
-.PHONY : sgml templates scan
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util-decl.txt b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util-decl.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index eb108b868f..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util-decl.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,852 +0,0 @@
-<MACRO>
-<NAME>CAL_COMPONENT_TYPE</NAME>
-#define CAL_COMPONENT_TYPE (cal_component_get_type ())
-</MACRO>
-<MACRO>
-<NAME>CAL_COMPONENT</NAME>
-#define CAL_COMPONENT(obj) (GTK_CHECK_CAST ((obj), CAL_COMPONENT_TYPE, CalComponent))
-</MACRO>
-<MACRO>
-<NAME>CAL_COMPONENT_CLASS</NAME>
-#define CAL_COMPONENT_CLASS(klass) (GTK_CHECK_CLASS_CAST ((klass), CAL_COMPONENT_TYPE, \
- CalComponentClass))
-</MACRO>
-<MACRO>
-<NAME>IS_CAL_COMPONENT</NAME>
-#define IS_CAL_COMPONENT(obj) (GTK_CHECK_TYPE ((obj), CAL_COMPONENT_TYPE))
-</MACRO>
-<MACRO>
-<NAME>IS_CAL_COMPONENT_CLASS</NAME>
-#define IS_CAL_COMPONENT_CLASS(klass) (GTK_CHECK_CLASS_TYPE ((klass), CAL_COMPONENT_TYPE))
-</MACRO>
-<ENUM>
-<NAME>CalComponentVType</NAME>
-typedef enum {
- CAL_COMPONENT_NO_TYPE,
- CAL_COMPONENT_EVENT,
- CAL_COMPONENT_TODO,
- CAL_COMPONENT_JOURNAL,
- CAL_COMPONENT_FREEBUSY,
- CAL_COMPONENT_TIMEZONE
-} CalComponentVType;
-</ENUM>
-<ENUM>
-<NAME>CalComponentField</NAME>
-typedef enum {
- CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_CATEGORIES, /* concatenation of the categories list */
- CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_CLASSIFICATION,
- CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_COMPLETED,
- CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_DTEND,
- CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_DTSTART,
- CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_DUE,
- CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_GEO,
- CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_PERCENT,
- CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_PRIORITY,
- CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_SUMMARY,
- CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_TRANSPARENCY,
- CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_URL,
- CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_HAS_ALARMS, /* not a real field */
- CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_ICON, /* not a real field */
- CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_COMPLETE, /* not a real field */
- CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_RECURRING, /* not a real field */
- CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_OVERDUE, /* not a real field */
- CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_COLOR, /* not a real field */
- CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_NUM_FIELDS
-} CalComponentField;
-</ENUM>
-<ENUM>
-<NAME>CalComponentClassification</NAME>
-typedef enum {
- CAL_COMPONENT_CLASS_NONE,
- CAL_COMPONENT_CLASS_PUBLIC,
- CAL_COMPONENT_CLASS_PRIVATE,
- CAL_COMPONENT_CLASS_CONFIDENTIAL,
- CAL_COMPONENT_CLASS_UNKNOWN
-} CalComponentClassification;
-</ENUM>
-<TYPEDEF>
-<NAME>CalComponentDateTime</NAME>
-typedef struct {
- /* Actual date/time value */
- struct icaltimetype *value;
-
- /* Timezone ID */
- const char *tzid;
-} CalComponentDateTime;
-</TYPEDEF>
-<ENUM>
-<NAME>CalComponentPeriodType</NAME>
-typedef enum {
- CAL_COMPONENT_PERIOD_DATETIME,
- CAL_COMPONENT_PERIOD_DURATION
-} CalComponentPeriodType;
-</ENUM>
-<TYPEDEF>
-<NAME>CalComponentPeriod</NAME>
-typedef struct {
- CalComponentPeriodType type;
-
- struct icaltimetype start;
-
- union {
- struct icaltimetype end;
- struct icaldurationtype duration;
- } u;
-} CalComponentPeriod;
-</TYPEDEF>
-<TYPEDEF>
-<NAME>CalComponentText</NAME>
-typedef struct {
- /* Description string */
- const char *value;
-
- /* Alternate representation URI */
- const char *altrep;
-} CalComponentText;
-</TYPEDEF>
-<ENUM>
-<NAME>CalComponentTransparency</NAME>
-typedef enum {
- CAL_COMPONENT_TRANSP_NONE,
- CAL_COMPONENT_TRANSP_TRANSPARENT,
- CAL_COMPONENT_TRANSP_OPAQUE,
- CAL_COMPONENT_TRANSP_UNKNOWN
-} CalComponentTransparency;
-</ENUM>
-<STRUCT>
-<NAME>CalComponentAlarm</NAME>
-</STRUCT>
-<STRUCT>
-<NAME>CalComponent</NAME>
-</STRUCT>
-<STRUCT>
-<NAME>CalComponentClass</NAME>
-</STRUCT>
-<STRUCT>
-<NAME>CalComponentPrivate</NAME>
-</STRUCT>
-<STRUCT>
-<NAME>CalComponent</NAME>
-struct CalComponent {
- GtkObject object;
-
- /* Private data */
- CalComponentPrivate *priv;
-};
-</STRUCT>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_type</NAME>
-<RETURNS>GtkType </RETURNS>
-void
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_gen_uid</NAME>
-<RETURNS>char *</RETURNS>
-void
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_new</NAME>
-<RETURNS>CalComponent *</RETURNS>
-void
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_clone</NAME>
-<RETURNS>CalComponent *</RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_new_vtype</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, CalComponentVType type
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_icalcomponent</NAME>
-<RETURNS>gboolean </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, icalcomponent *icalcomp
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_icalcomponent</NAME>
-<RETURNS>icalcomponent *</RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_vtype</NAME>
-<RETURNS>CalComponentVType </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_as_string</NAME>
-<RETURNS>char *</RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_commit_sequence</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_uid</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, const char **uid
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_uid</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, const char *uid
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_categories_list</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, GSList **categ_list
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_categories_list</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, GSList *categ_list
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_classification</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, CalComponentClassification *classif
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_classification</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, CalComponentClassification classif
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_comment_list</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, GSList **text_list
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_comment_list</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, GSList *text_list
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_completed</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, struct icaltimetype **t
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_completed</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, struct icaltimetype *t
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_created</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, struct icaltimetype **t
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_created</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, struct icaltimetype *t
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_description_list</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, GSList **text_list
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_description_list</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, GSList *text_list
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_dtend</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, CalComponentDateTime *dt
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_dtend</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, CalComponentDateTime *dt
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_dtstamp</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, struct icaltimetype *t
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_dtstamp</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, struct icaltimetype *t
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_dtstart</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, CalComponentDateTime *dt
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_dtstart</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, CalComponentDateTime *dt
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_due</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, CalComponentDateTime *dt
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_due</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, CalComponentDateTime *dt
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_exdate_list</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, GSList **exdate_list
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_exdate_list</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, GSList *exdate_list
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_exrule_list</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, GSList **recur_list
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_exrule_list</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, GSList *recur_list
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_geo</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, struct icalgeotype **geo
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_geo</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, struct icalgeotype *geo
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_last_modified</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, struct icaltimetype **t
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_last_modified</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, struct icaltimetype *t
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_percent</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, int **percent
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_percent</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, int *percent
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_priority</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, int **priority
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_priority</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, int *priority
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_rdate_list</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, GSList **period_list
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_rdate_list</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, GSList *period_list
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_has_rdates</NAME>
-<RETURNS>gboolean </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_rrule_list</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, GSList **recur_list
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_rrule_list</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, GSList *recur_list
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_has_rrules</NAME>
-<RETURNS>gboolean </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_sequence</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, int **sequence
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_sequence</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, int *sequence
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_summary</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, CalComponentText *summary
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_summary</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, CalComponentText *summary
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_transparency</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, CalComponentTransparency *transp
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_transparency</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, CalComponentTransparency transp
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_url</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, const char **url
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_url</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, const char *url
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_pilot_id</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, unsigned long *pilot_id
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_pilot_id</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, unsigned long pilot_id
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_pilot_status</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, unsigned long *pilot_status
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_set_pilot_status</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp, unsigned long pilot_status
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_free_categories_list</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-GSList *categ_list
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_free_datetime</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponentDateTime *dt
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_free_exdate_list</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-GSList *exdate_list
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_free_geo</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-struct icalgeotype *geo
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_free_icaltimetype</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-struct icaltimetype *t
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_free_percent</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-int *percent
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_free_priority</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-int *priority
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_free_period_list</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-GSList *period_list
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_free_recur_list</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-GSList *recur_list
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_free_sequence</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-int *sequence
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_free_text_list</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-GSList *text_list
-</FUNCTION>
-<ENUM>
-<NAME>CalComponentAlarmAction</NAME>
-typedef enum {
- CAL_COMPONENT_ALARM_NONE,
- CAL_COMPONENT_ALARM_AUDIO,
- CAL_COMPONENT_ALARM_DISPLAY,
- CAL_COMPONENT_ALARM_EMAIL,
- CAL_COMPONENT_ALARM_PROCEDURE,
- CAL_COMPONENT_ALARM_UNKNOWN
-} CalComponentAlarmAction;
-</ENUM>
-<ENUM>
-<NAME>CalComponentAlarmTriggerType</NAME>
-typedef enum {
- CAL_COMPONENT_ALARM_TRIGGER_RELATIVE,
- CAL_COMPONENT_ALARM_TRIGGER_ABSOLUTE
-} CalComponentAlarmTriggerType;
-</ENUM>
-<ENUM>
-<NAME>CalComponentAlarmTriggerRelated</NAME>
-typedef enum {
- CAL_COMPONENT_ALARM_TRIGGER_RELATED_START,
- CAL_COMPONENT_ALARM_TRIGGER_RELATED_END
-} CalComponentAlarmTriggerRelated;
-</ENUM>
-<TYPEDEF>
-<NAME>CalComponentAlarmTrigger</NAME>
-typedef struct {
- CalComponentAlarmTriggerType type;
-
- union {
- struct {
- struct icaldurationtype duration;
- CalComponentAlarmTriggerRelated related;
- } relative;
-
- struct icaltimetype absolute;
- } u;
-} CalComponentAlarmTrigger;
-</TYPEDEF>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_first_alarm</NAME>
-<RETURNS>CalComponentAlarm *</RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_get_next_alarm</NAME>
-<RETURNS>CalComponentAlarm *</RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_alarm_free</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponentAlarm *alarm
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_alarm_get_action</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponentAlarm *alarm, CalComponentAlarmAction *action
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_alarm_set_action</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponentAlarm *alarm, CalComponentAlarmAction action
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_alarm_get_trigger</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponentAlarm *alarm, CalComponentAlarmTrigger **trigger
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_alarm_set_trigger</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponentAlarm *alarm, CalComponentAlarmTrigger *trigger
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_component_alarm_free_trigger</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponentAlarmTrigger *trigger
-</FUNCTION>
-<ENUM>
-<NAME>CalRecurType</NAME>
-typedef enum {
- CAL_RECUR_YEARLY,
- CAL_RECUR_MONTHLY,
- CAL_RECUR_WEEKLY,
- CAL_RECUR_DAILY,
- CAL_RECUR_HOURLY,
- CAL_RECUR_MINUTELY,
- CAL_RECUR_SECONDLY
-} CalRecurType;
-</ENUM>
-<TYPEDEF>
-<NAME>CalRecurrence</NAME>
-typedef struct {
- CalRecurType type;
-
- int interval;
-
- /* Specifies the end of the recurrence. No occurrences are generated
- after this date. If it is 0, the event recurs forever. */
- time_t enddate;
-
- /* WKST property - the week start day: 0 = Monday to 6 = Sunday. */
- gint week_start_day;
-
-
- /* NOTE: I've used GList's here, but it doesn't matter if we use
- other data structures like arrays. The code should be easy to
- change. So long as it is easy to see if the modifier is set. */
-
- /* For BYMONTH modifier. A list of GINT_TO_POINTERs, 0-11. */
- GList *bymonth;
-
- /* For BYWEEKNO modifier. A list of GINT_TO_POINTERs, [+-]1-53. */
- GList *byweekno;
-
- /* For BYYEARDAY modifier. A list of GINT_TO_POINTERs, [+-]1-366. */
- GList *byyearday;
-
- /* For BYMONTHDAY modifier. A list of GINT_TO_POINTERs, [+-]1-31. */
- GList *bymonthday;
-
- /* For BYDAY modifier. A list of GINT_TO_POINTERs, in pairs.
- The first of each pair is the weekday, 0 = Monday to 6 = Sunday.
- The second of each pair is the week number [+-]0-53. */
- GList *byday;
-
- /* For BYHOUR modifier. A list of GINT_TO_POINTERs, 0-23. */
- GList *byhour;
-
- /* For BYMINUTE modifier. A list of GINT_TO_POINTERs, 0-59. */
- GList *byminute;
-
- /* For BYSECOND modifier. A list of GINT_TO_POINTERs, 0-60. */
- GList *bysecond;
-
- /* For BYSETPOS modifier. A list of GINT_TO_POINTERs, +ve or -ve. */
- GList *bysetpos;
-} CalRecurrence;
-</TYPEDEF>
-<STRUCT>
-<NAME>CalObjTime</NAME>
-</STRUCT>
-<STRUCT>
-<NAME>CalObjTime</NAME>
-struct CalObjTime {
- guint16 year;
- guint8 month; /* 0 - 11 */
- guint8 day; /* 1 - 31 */
- guint8 hour; /* 0 - 23 */
- guint8 minute; /* 0 - 59 */
- guint8 second; /* 0 - 59 (maybe 60 for leap second) */
-};
-</STRUCT>
-<USER_FUNCTION>
-<NAME>CalRecurInstanceFn</NAME>
-<RETURNS>gboolean </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp,
- time_t instance_start,
- time_t instace_end,
- gpointer data
-</USER_FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_recur_generate_instances</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalComponent *comp,time_t start,time_t end,CalRecurInstanceFn cb,gpointer cb_data
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_recur_from_icalrecurrencetype</NAME>
-<RETURNS>CalRecurrence *</RETURNS>
-struct icalrecurrencetype *ir
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_recur_free</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-CalRecurrence *r
-</FUNCTION>
-<TYPEDEF>
-<NAME>CalObjInstance</NAME>
-typedef struct {
- char *uid; /* UID of the object */
- time_t start; /* Start time of instance */
- time_t end; /* End time of instance */
-} CalObjInstance;
-</TYPEDEF>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_obj_instance_list_free</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-GList *list
-</FUNCTION>
-<TYPEDEF>
-<NAME>CalAlarmInstance</NAME>
-typedef struct {
- char *uid; /* UID of object */
-#if 0
- enum AlarmType type; /* Type of alarm */
-#endif
- time_t trigger; /* Alarm trigger time */
- time_t occur; /* Occurrence time */
-} CalAlarmInstance;
-</TYPEDEF>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_alarm_instance_list_free</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-GList *list
-</FUNCTION>
-<ENUM>
-<NAME>CalObjType</NAME>
-typedef enum {
- CALOBJ_TYPE_EVENT = 1 << 0,
- CALOBJ_TYPE_TODO = 1 << 1,
- CALOBJ_TYPE_JOURNAL = 1 << 2,
- CALOBJ_TYPE_ANY = 0x07
-} CalObjType;
-</ENUM>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>cal_obj_uid_list_free</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-GList *list
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>time_from_icaltimetype</NAME>
-<RETURNS>time_t </RETURNS>
-struct icaltimetype itt
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>time_from_isodate</NAME>
-<RETURNS>time_t </RETURNS>
-char *str
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>time_from_start_duration</NAME>
-<RETURNS>time_t </RETURNS>
-time_t start, char *duration
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>isodate_from_time_t</NAME>
-<RETURNS>char *</RETURNS>
-time_t t
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>get_time_t_hour</NAME>
-<RETURNS>int </RETURNS>
-time_t t
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>isodiff_to_secs</NAME>
-<RETURNS>int </RETURNS>
-char *str
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>isodiff_from_secs</NAME>
-<RETURNS>char *</RETURNS>
-int secs
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>time_add_minutes</NAME>
-<RETURNS>time_t </RETURNS>
-time_t time, int minutes
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>time_add_day</NAME>
-<RETURNS>time_t </RETURNS>
-time_t time, int days
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>time_add_week</NAME>
-<RETURNS>time_t </RETURNS>
-time_t time, int weeks
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>time_add_month</NAME>
-<RETURNS>time_t </RETURNS>
-time_t time, int months
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>time_add_year</NAME>
-<RETURNS>time_t </RETURNS>
-time_t time, int years
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>format_simple_hour</NAME>
-<RETURNS>char *</RETURNS>
-int hour, int use_am_pm
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>time_days_in_month</NAME>
-<RETURNS>int </RETURNS>
-int year, int month
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>time_from_day</NAME>
-<RETURNS>time_t </RETURNS>
-int year, int month, int day
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>time_day_hour</NAME>
-<RETURNS>time_t </RETURNS>
-time_t t, int hour
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>time_year_begin</NAME>
-<RETURNS>time_t </RETURNS>
-time_t t
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>time_year_end</NAME>
-<RETURNS>time_t </RETURNS>
-time_t t
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>time_month_begin</NAME>
-<RETURNS>time_t </RETURNS>
-time_t t
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>time_month_end</NAME>
-<RETURNS>time_t </RETURNS>
-time_t t
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>time_week_begin</NAME>
-<RETURNS>time_t </RETURNS>
-time_t t
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>time_week_end</NAME>
-<RETURNS>time_t </RETURNS>
-time_t t
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>time_day_begin</NAME>
-<RETURNS>time_t </RETURNS>
-time_t t
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>time_day_end</NAME>
-<RETURNS>time_t </RETURNS>
-time_t t
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>parse_date</NAME>
-<RETURNS>time_t </RETURNS>
-char *str
-</FUNCTION>
-<FUNCTION>
-<NAME>print_time_t</NAME>
-<RETURNS>void </RETURNS>
-time_t t
-</FUNCTION>
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util-sections.txt b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util-sections.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index cd928fc7e3..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util-sections.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,166 +0,0 @@
-<SECTION>
-<FILE>cal-component</FILE>
-CAL_COMPONENT
-<TITLE>CalComponent</TITLE>
-
-CalComponentVType
-CalComponentField
-CalComponentClassification
-CalComponentDateTime
-CalComponentPeriodType
-CalComponentPeriod
-CalComponentText
-CalComponentTransparency
-CalComponentAlarm
-CalComponentPrivate
-
-cal_component_gen_uid
-cal_component_new
-cal_component_clone
-cal_component_set_new_vtype
-cal_component_set_icalcomponent
-cal_component_get_icalcomponent
-cal_component_get_vtype
-cal_component_get_as_string
-cal_component_commit_sequence
-cal_component_get_uid
-cal_component_set_uid
-cal_component_get_categories_list
-cal_component_set_categories_list
-cal_component_get_classification
-cal_component_set_classification
-cal_component_get_comment_list
-cal_component_set_comment_list
-cal_component_get_completed
-cal_component_set_completed
-cal_component_get_created
-cal_component_set_created
-cal_component_get_description_list
-cal_component_set_description_list
-cal_component_get_dtend
-cal_component_set_dtend
-cal_component_get_dtstamp
-cal_component_set_dtstamp
-cal_component_get_dtstart
-cal_component_set_dtstart
-cal_component_get_due
-cal_component_set_due
-cal_component_get_exdate_list
-cal_component_set_exdate_list
-cal_component_get_exrule_list
-cal_component_set_exrule_list
-cal_component_get_geo
-cal_component_set_geo
-cal_component_get_last_modified
-cal_component_set_last_modified
-cal_component_get_percent
-cal_component_set_percent
-cal_component_get_priority
-cal_component_set_priority
-cal_component_get_rdate_list
-cal_component_set_rdate_list
-cal_component_has_rdates
-cal_component_get_rrule_list
-cal_component_set_rrule_list
-cal_component_has_rrules
-cal_component_get_sequence
-cal_component_set_sequence
-cal_component_get_summary
-cal_component_set_summary
-cal_component_get_transparency
-cal_component_set_transparency
-cal_component_get_url
-cal_component_set_url
-cal_component_get_pilot_id
-cal_component_set_pilot_id
-cal_component_get_pilot_status
-cal_component_set_pilot_status
-
-cal_component_free_categories_list
-cal_component_free_datetime
-cal_component_free_exdate_list
-cal_component_free_geo
-cal_component_free_icaltimetype
-cal_component_free_percent
-cal_component_free_priority
-cal_component_free_period_list
-cal_component_free_recur_list
-cal_component_free_sequence
-cal_component_free_text_list
-
-CalComponentAlarmAction
-CalComponentAlarmTriggerType
-CalComponentAlarmTriggerRelated
-CalComponentAlarmTrigger
-
-cal_component_get_first_alarm
-cal_component_get_next_alarm
-cal_component_alarm_free
-cal_component_alarm_get_action
-cal_component_alarm_set_action
-cal_component_alarm_get_trigger
-cal_component_alarm_set_trigger
-cal_component_alarm_free_trigger
-
-<SUBSECTION Standard>
-CAL_COMPONENT_TYPE
-CAL_COMPONENT_CLASS
-IS_CAL_COMPONENT
-IS_CAL_COMPONENT_CLASS
-cal_component_get_type
-
-<SUBSECTION Private>
-CalComponent
-
-</SECTION>
-
-<SECTION>
-<FILE>cal-recur</FILE>
-CalRecurType
-CalRecurrence
-CalObjTime
-CalRecurInstanceFn
-cal_recur_generate_instances
-cal_recur_from_icalrecurrencetype
-cal_recur_free
-</SECTION>
-
-<SECTION>
-<FILE>cal-util</FILE>
-CalObjInstance
-cal_obj_instance_list_free
-CalAlarmInstance
-cal_alarm_instance_list_free
-CalObjType
-cal_obj_uid_list_free
-</SECTION>
-
-<SECTION>
-<FILE>timeutil</FILE>
-time_from_icaltimetype
-time_from_isodate
-time_from_start_duration
-isodate_from_time_t
-get_time_t_hour
-isodiff_to_secs
-isodiff_from_secs
-time_add_minutes
-time_add_day
-time_add_week
-time_add_month
-time_add_year
-format_simple_hour
-time_days_in_month
-time_from_day
-time_day_hour
-time_year_begin
-time_year_end
-time_month_begin
-time_month_end
-time_week_begin
-time_week_end
-time_day_begin
-time_day_end
-parse_date
-print_time_t
-</SECTION>
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util.args b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util.args
deleted file mode 100644
index e69de29bb2..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util.args
+++ /dev/null
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util.hierarchy b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util.hierarchy
deleted file mode 100644
index cc235653f2..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util.hierarchy
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,2 +0,0 @@
-GtkObject
- CalComponent
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util.signals b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util.signals
deleted file mode 100644
index e69de29bb2..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util.signals
+++ /dev/null
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util.types b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util.types
deleted file mode 100644
index 52b2d9bf90..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/evolution-cal-util.types
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,4 +0,0 @@
-#include <gnome.h>
-#include <cal-util/cal-component.h>
-
-cal_component_get_type
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/tmpl/cal-component.sgml b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/tmpl/cal-component.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index 2f800e583f..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/tmpl/cal-component.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,934 +0,0 @@
-<!-- ##### SECTION Title ##### -->
-CalComponent
-
-<!-- ##### SECTION Short_Description ##### -->
-RFC 2445 iCalendar component object.
-
-<!-- ##### SECTION Long_Description ##### -->
- <para>
- The #CalComponent object provides a wrapper over the &libical;
- functions for manipulating calendar components. #CalComponent
- presents a GTK+-like interface to calendar components according to
- RFC 2445.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- While &libical; supports almost all of the features of the
- iCalendar RFCs, applications are normally not interested in all
- the mindless gunk that is there. Still, applications should do
- their best not to drop extension fields from calendar components
- or any other extra information they do not support (including
- standard fields they are not interested in). The #CalComponent
- object provides a wrapper over
- <structname>icalcomponent</structname> structures from &libical;
- so that no information in them will be lost even if the
- application is not designed to handle it. Also, #CalComponent
- provides a higher-level API to many of the &libical; operations so
- as to make it less painful to deal with iCalendar components.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- A #CalComponent object starts out empty. It must be initialized
- from an existing <structname>icalcomponent</structname> structure
- by using the cal_component_set_icalcomponent() function, or from a
- completely new data by specifying the desired component type to
- the cal_component_set_new_vtype() function.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- #CalComponent will create an internal map of the properties in the
- <structname>icalcomponent</structname> structure and then allow
- random access to them via the #CalComponent API functions;
- normally the &libical; API would have to be used by creating many
- iterators and other unpleasant constructs. #CalComponent keeps
- handles to the properties it scanned from the
- <structname>icalcomponent</structname> and will let the parent
- application modify them at any time without having to do any
- iteration.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Eventually a #CalComponent may be turned into the RFC 2445 string
- representation of an iCalendar component by using the
- cal_component_get_as_string() function. Applications can then
- transfer this interoperable
- <footnote>
- <para>
- &ldquo;Interoperable.&rdquo; Heavens, I love that word.
- </para>
- </footnote>
- string to other programs that deal with iCalendar.
- </para>
-
-<!-- ##### SECTION See_Also ##### -->
- <para>
-
- </para>
-
-<!-- ##### MACRO CAL_COMPONENT ##### -->
- <para>
- Casts a #GtkObject to a #CalComponent.
- </para>
-
-@obj: A GTK+ object.
-
-
-<!-- ##### ENUM CalComponentVType ##### -->
- <para>
- Calendar component types as defined by RFC 2445. These values can
- be used to create a new calendar component by passing them to the
- cal_component_set_new_vtype() function. They are also the return
- value of the cal_component_get_vtype() function. The only time
- the @CAL_COMPONENT_NO_TYPE value is used is when querying the
- vtype of an uninitialized #CalComponent.
- </para>
-
-@CAL_COMPONENT_NO_TYPE: Returned from cal_component_get_vtype() to
- indicate an uninitialized #CalComponent object.
-
-@CAL_COMPONENT_EVENT: Indicates a VEVENT component.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_TODO: Indicates a VTODO component.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_JOURNAL: Indicates a VJOURNAL component.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_FREEBUSY: Indicates a VFREEBUSY component.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_TIMEZONE: Indicates a VTIMEZOME component.
-
-<!-- ##### ENUM CalComponentField ##### -->
- <para>
- These values are used as identifiers for #ETable columns. These
- are used by the calendar GUI code in Evolution.
- </para>
-
-@CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_CATEGORIES: Component's list of categories.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_CLASSIFICATION: Component's classification.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_COMPLETED: Component's completion date.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_DTEND: Component's ending date.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_DTSTART: Component's starting date.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_DUE: Component's due date.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_GEO: Component's geographical position.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_PERCENT: Component's percent completed value.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_PRIORITY: Component's priority.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_SUMMARY: Component's summary.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_TRANSPARENCY: Component's transparency value.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_URL: Component's URL.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_HAS_ALARMS: Whether the component has any alarms.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_ICON: Which icon to use for the component.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_COMPLETE: Whether the component has been completed.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_RECURRING: Whether the component has any recurrences.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_OVERDUE: Whether the component is overdue.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_COLOR: Which color to use for the component.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_FIELD_NUM_FIELDS: Total number of enumerated fields.
-
-<!-- ##### ENUM CalComponentClassification ##### -->
- <para>
- Values for the access classification property of a calendar
- component.
- </para>
-
-@CAL_COMPONENT_CLASS_NONE: Indicates that no access classification has
- been set for the corresponding component.
-
-@CAL_COMPONENT_CLASS_PUBLIC: Public access.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_CLASS_PRIVATE: Private access.
-@CAL_COMPONENT_CLASS_CONFIDENTIAL: Confidential access.
-
-@CAL_COMPONENT_CLASS_UNKNOWN: Unknown access classification value,
- used when &libical; returns something #CalComponent does not know
- about.
-
-<!-- ##### TYPEDEF CalComponentDateTime ##### -->
- <para>
- This structure defines a date and time value.
- </para>
-
-
-<!-- ##### ENUM CalComponentPeriodType ##### -->
- <para>
- Defines how a period of time is specified.
- </para>
-
-@CAL_COMPONENT_PERIOD_DATETIME: Indicates that the period is specified
- by starting and ending date/time values.
-
-@CAL_COMPONENT_PERIOD_DURATION: Indicates that the period is specified
- as a starding date/time and a duration value.
-
-<!-- ##### TYPEDEF CalComponentPeriod ##### -->
- <para>
- This structure defines a period of time.
- </para>
-
-
-<!-- ##### TYPEDEF CalComponentText ##### -->
- <para>
- This structure defines the value of a text property that may have
- an alternate representation parameter.
- </para>
-
-
-<!-- ##### ENUM CalComponentTransparency ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@CAL_COMPONENT_TRANSP_NONE:
-@CAL_COMPONENT_TRANSP_TRANSPARENT:
-@CAL_COMPONENT_TRANSP_OPAQUE:
-@CAL_COMPONENT_TRANSP_UNKNOWN:
-
-<!-- ##### STRUCT CalComponentAlarm ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-
-<!-- ##### STRUCT CalComponentPrivate ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_gen_uid ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_new ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_clone ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_new_vtype ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@type:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_icalcomponent ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@icalcomp:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_icalcomponent ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_vtype ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_as_string ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_commit_sequence ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_uid ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@uid:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_uid ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@uid:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_categories_list ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@categ_list:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_categories_list ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@categ_list:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_classification ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@classif:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_classification ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@classif:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_comment_list ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@text_list:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_comment_list ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@text_list:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_completed ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@t:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_completed ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@t:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_created ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@t:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_created ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@t:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_description_list ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@text_list:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_description_list ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@text_list:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_dtend ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@dt:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_dtend ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@dt:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_dtstamp ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@t:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_dtstamp ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@t:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_dtstart ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@dt:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_dtstart ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@dt:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_due ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@dt:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_due ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@dt:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_exdate_list ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@exdate_list:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_exdate_list ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@exdate_list:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_exrule_list ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@recur_list:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_exrule_list ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@recur_list:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_geo ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@geo:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_geo ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@geo:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_last_modified ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@t:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_last_modified ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@t:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_percent ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@percent:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_percent ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@percent:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_priority ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@priority:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_priority ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@priority:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_rdate_list ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@period_list:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_rdate_list ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@period_list:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_has_rdates ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_rrule_list ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@recur_list:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_rrule_list ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@recur_list:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_has_rrules ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_sequence ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@sequence:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_sequence ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@sequence:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_summary ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@summary:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_summary ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@summary:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_transparency ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@transp:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_transparency ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@transp:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_url ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@url:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_url ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@url:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_pilot_id ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@pilot_id:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_pilot_id ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@pilot_id:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_pilot_status ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@pilot_status:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_set_pilot_status ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@pilot_status:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_free_categories_list ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@categ_list:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_free_datetime ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@dt:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_free_exdate_list ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@exdate_list:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_free_geo ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@geo:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_free_icaltimetype ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@t:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_free_percent ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@percent:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_free_priority ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@priority:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_free_period_list ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@period_list:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_free_recur_list ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@recur_list:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_free_sequence ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@sequence:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_free_text_list ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@text_list:
-
-
-<!-- ##### ENUM CalComponentAlarmAction ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@CAL_COMPONENT_ALARM_NONE:
-@CAL_COMPONENT_ALARM_AUDIO:
-@CAL_COMPONENT_ALARM_DISPLAY:
-@CAL_COMPONENT_ALARM_EMAIL:
-@CAL_COMPONENT_ALARM_PROCEDURE:
-@CAL_COMPONENT_ALARM_UNKNOWN:
-
-<!-- ##### ENUM CalComponentAlarmTriggerType ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@CAL_COMPONENT_ALARM_TRIGGER_RELATIVE:
-@CAL_COMPONENT_ALARM_TRIGGER_ABSOLUTE:
-
-<!-- ##### ENUM CalComponentAlarmTriggerRelated ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@CAL_COMPONENT_ALARM_TRIGGER_RELATED_START:
-@CAL_COMPONENT_ALARM_TRIGGER_RELATED_END:
-
-<!-- ##### TYPEDEF CalComponentAlarmTrigger ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_first_alarm ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_get_next_alarm ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_alarm_free ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@alarm:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_alarm_get_action ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@alarm:
-@action:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_alarm_set_action ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@alarm:
-@action:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_alarm_get_trigger ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@alarm:
-@trigger:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_alarm_set_trigger ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@alarm:
-@trigger:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_component_alarm_free_trigger ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@trigger:
-
-
-<!--
-Local variables:
-mode: sgml
-sgml-parent-document: ("../../../evolution-devel-guide.sgml" "book" "refsect2" "")
-End:
--->
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/tmpl/cal-recur.sgml b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/tmpl/cal-recur.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index 703f8b2b85..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/tmpl/cal-recur.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,88 +0,0 @@
-<!-- ##### SECTION Title ##### -->
-cal-recur
-
-<!-- ##### SECTION Short_Description ##### -->
-
-
-<!-- ##### SECTION Long_Description ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-<!-- ##### SECTION See_Also ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-<!-- ##### ENUM CalRecurType ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@CAL_RECUR_YEARLY:
-@CAL_RECUR_MONTHLY:
-@CAL_RECUR_WEEKLY:
-@CAL_RECUR_DAILY:
-@CAL_RECUR_HOURLY:
-@CAL_RECUR_MINUTELY:
-@CAL_RECUR_SECONDLY:
-
-<!-- ##### TYPEDEF CalRecurrence ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-
-<!-- ##### STRUCT CalObjTime ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@year:
-@month:
-@day:
-@hour:
-@minute:
-@second:
-
-<!-- ##### USER_FUNCTION CalRecurInstanceFn ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@instance_start:
-@instace_end:
-@data:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_recur_generate_instances ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@comp:
-@start:
-@end:
-@cb:
-@cb_data:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_recur_from_icalrecurrencetype ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@ir:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_recur_free ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@r:
-
-
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/tmpl/cal-util.sgml b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/tmpl/cal-util.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index bc349a377f..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/tmpl/cal-util.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,62 +0,0 @@
-<!-- ##### SECTION Title ##### -->
-Miscellaneous utilities
-
-<!-- ##### SECTION Short_Description ##### -->
-
-
-<!-- ##### SECTION Long_Description ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-<!-- ##### SECTION See_Also ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-<!-- ##### TYPEDEF CalObjInstance ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_obj_instance_list_free ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@list:
-
-
-<!-- ##### TYPEDEF CalAlarmInstance ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_alarm_instance_list_free ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@list:
-
-
-<!-- ##### ENUM CalObjType ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@CALOBJ_TYPE_EVENT:
-@CALOBJ_TYPE_TODO:
-@CALOBJ_TYPE_JOURNAL:
-@CALOBJ_TYPE_ANY:
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION cal_obj_uid_list_free ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@list:
-
-
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/tmpl/evolution-cal-util-unused.sgml b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/tmpl/evolution-cal-util-unused.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index e69de29bb2..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/tmpl/evolution-cal-util-unused.sgml
+++ /dev/null
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/tmpl/timeutil.sgml b/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/tmpl/timeutil.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index 3b62fbba3f..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/cal-util/tmpl/timeutil.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,260 +0,0 @@
-<!-- ##### SECTION Title ##### -->
-timeutil
-
-<!-- ##### SECTION Short_Description ##### -->
-
-
-<!-- ##### SECTION Long_Description ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-<!-- ##### SECTION See_Also ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION time_from_icaltimetype ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@itt:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION time_from_isodate ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@str:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION time_from_start_duration ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@start:
-@duration:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION isodate_from_time_t ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@t:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION get_time_t_hour ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@t:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION isodiff_to_secs ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@str:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION isodiff_from_secs ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@secs:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION time_add_minutes ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@time:
-@minutes:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION time_add_day ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@time:
-@days:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION time_add_week ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@time:
-@weeks:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION time_add_month ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@time:
-@months:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION time_add_year ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@time:
-@years:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION format_simple_hour ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@hour:
-@use_am_pm:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION time_days_in_month ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@year:
-@month:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION time_from_day ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@year:
-@month:
-@day:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION time_day_hour ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@t:
-@hour:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION time_year_begin ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@t:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION time_year_end ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@t:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION time_month_begin ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@t:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION time_month_end ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@t:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION time_week_begin ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@t:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION time_week_end ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@t:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION time_day_begin ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@t:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION time_day_end ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@t:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION parse_date ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@str:
-@Returns:
-
-
-<!-- ##### FUNCTION print_time_t ##### -->
-<para>
-
-</para>
-
-@t:
-
-
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/evolution-calendar.sgml b/doc/devel/calendar/evolution-calendar.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index f3936d9bbc..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/evolution-calendar.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,51 +0,0 @@
- <part>
- <docinfo>
- <authorgroup>
- <author>
- <firstname>Federico</firstname>
- <surname>Mena Quintero</surname>
- <affiliation>
- <address>
- <email>federico@helixcode.com</email>
- </address>
- </affiliation>
- </author>
- </authorgroup>
- </docinfo>
-
- <title>Developing Applications for the Evolution Calendar</title>
-
- <partintro>
- <para>
- This part of the Evolution Developer's Guide describes how to
- write applications for the Evolution Calendar by using its
- public interfaces. The Evolution Calendar exports its
- functionality through a number of interfaces, including CORBA,
- GTK+ wrappers for Bonobo objects, and other utility libraries.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- You should read this part of the Evolution Developer's guide
- if you intend to write client applications that use the
- functionality of the Evolution Calendar.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- This part does not describe the internal interfaces of the
- Evolution Calendar; for that you should read the Evolution
- Internals Guide. You should only need to read that guide if
- you are interested in the way the calendar works internally or
- if you want to make changes directly to the Evolution Calendar
- code.
- </para>
- </partintro>
-
- &calendar-architecture;
- </part>
-
-<!--
-Local variables:
-mode: sgml
-sgml-parent-document: ("../evolution-devel-guide.sgml" "book" "book" "")
-End:
--->
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/public-reference.sgml b/doc/devel/calendar/public-reference.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index f8aa6e848d..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/public-reference.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,24 +0,0 @@
- <reference>
- <title>Calendar Public API Reference</title>
-
- <partintro>
- <para>
- This part presents the class and function reference for the
- public APIs of the different components of the Evolution
- Calendar.
- </para>
- </partintro>
-
- &CalClient;
- &CalComponent;
- &cal-util;
- &cal-recur;
- &timeutil;
- </reference>
-
-<!--
-Local variables:
-mode: sgml
-sgml-parent-document: ("../evolution-devel-guide.sgml" "book" "part" "")
-End:
--->
diff --git a/doc/devel/calendar/reference.sgml b/doc/devel/calendar/reference.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index f8aa6e848d..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/calendar/reference.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,24 +0,0 @@
- <reference>
- <title>Calendar Public API Reference</title>
-
- <partintro>
- <para>
- This part presents the class and function reference for the
- public APIs of the different components of the Evolution
- Calendar.
- </para>
- </partintro>
-
- &CalClient;
- &CalComponent;
- &cal-util;
- &cal-recur;
- &timeutil;
- </reference>
-
-<!--
-Local variables:
-mode: sgml
-sgml-parent-document: ("../evolution-devel-guide.sgml" "book" "part" "")
-End:
--->
diff --git a/doc/devel/evolution-devel-guide.sgml b/doc/devel/evolution-devel-guide.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index 9db8f1bdf0..0000000000
--- a/doc/devel/evolution-devel-guide.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,50 +0,0 @@
-<!doctype book PUBLIC "-//Davenport//DTD DocBook V3.0//EN" [
-<!entity evolution-calendar SYSTEM "calendar/evolution-calendar.sgml">
-<!entity calendar-architecture SYSTEM "calendar/architecture.sgml">
-<!entity calendar-reference SYSTEM "calendar/reference.sgml">
-<!entity CalClient SYSTEM "calendar/cal-client/sgml/cal-client.sgml">
-<!entity CalComponent SYSTEM "calendar/cal-util/sgml/cal-component.sgml">
-<!entity cal-util SYSTEM "calendar/cal-util/sgml/cal-util.sgml">
-<!entity cal-recur SYSTEM "calendar/cal-util/sgml/cal-recur.sgml">
-<!entity timeutil SYSTEM "calendar/cal-util/sgml/timeutil.sgml">
-<!entity PCS "<acronym>PCS</acronym>">
-<!entity libical "<application>libical</application>">
-]>
-
-<book id="index">
- <bookinfo>
- <title>Evolution Developer's Guide</title>
-
- <authorgroup>
- <corpauthor>
- Helix Code, Inc.
- </corpauthor>
- </authorgroup>
-
- <copyright>
- <year>2000</year>
- <holder>Helix Code, Inc.</holder>
- </copyright>
- </bookinfo>
-
- <!-- DocBook parts for each individual component -->
-
- &evolution-calendar;
-
- <!-- API Reference part -->
-
- <part>
- <title>Evolution Public API Reference</title>
-
- <partintro>
- <para>
- This part presents the class and function reference for the
- different libraries and interfaces that Evolution provides.
- Classes are described together with their methods; individual
- functions are grouped by functional group.
- </para>
- </partintro>
-
- &calendar-reference;
- </part>
-</book>
diff --git a/doc/white-papers/calendar/calendar.sgml b/doc/white-papers/calendar/calendar.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index 2cb3132e2b..0000000000
--- a/doc/white-papers/calendar/calendar.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,209 +0,0 @@
-<!doctype article PUBLIC "-//Davenport//DTD DocBook V3.0//EN" [
-<!entity Evolution "<application>Evolution</application>">
-<!entity CUA "<acronym>CUA</acronym>">
-<!entity PCS "<acronym>PCS</acronym>">
-<!entity Bonobo "<application>Bonobo</application>">
-<!entity CORBA "<acronym>CORBA</acronym>">
-<!entity GTK "<acronym>GTK+</acronym>">
-]>
-
-<article class="whitepaper" id="calendar">
-
- <artheader>
- <title>&Evolution; Calendaring Framework</title>
-
- <authorgroup>
- <author>
- <firstname>Federico</firstname>
- <surname>Mena Quintero</surname>
- <affiliation>
- <address>
- <email>federico@helixcode.com</email>
- </address>
- </affiliation>
- </author>
- </authorgroup>
-
- <copyright>
- <year>2000</year>
- <holder>Helix Code, Inc.</holder>
- </copyright>
-
- <abstract>
- <para>
- The &Evolution; groupware suite provides a framework for
- developing calendaring applications, as well as a graphical
- calendar client and a personal calendar server. This white
- paper describes the architecture of the &Evolution;
- calendaring framework.
- </para>
- </abstract>
- </artheader>
-
- <!-- Introduction -->
-
- <sect1 id="introduction">
- <title>Introduction</title>
-
- <para>
- Calendaring is an important part of a groupware suite. A
- calendaring framework will allow a user to keep a personal
- calendar and have several applications use it. Such
- applications could be a graphical calendar client that the user
- employs to schedule appointments and keep track of his time, a
- <productname>Palm Pilot</productname> synchronization client, or
- a simple alarm or reminder utility. A comprehensive calendaring
- framework will also allow multiple users to schedule
- appointments between each other; for example, a project director
- may want to schedule a weekly meeting with the rest of the
- project members, or a person who owns a large house may want to
- schedule a big party with his friends. The attendees will then
- want to reply with messages such as, &ldquo;I will
- attend&rdquo;, or &ldquo;I will attend only if the proposed time
- is changed&rdquo;.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The &Evolution; groupware suite provides a framework for
- developing calendaring applications, as well as a graphical
- calendar client or calendar user agent (&CUA;) and a personal
- calendar server (&PCS;).
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The following sections explain the basic calendaring framework,
- the functions of the calendar user agent and the personal
- calendar server, and the relationship between the two.
- </para>
- </sect1>
-
- <!-- Personal Calendar Server -->
-
- <sect1 id="pcs">
- <title>Personal Calendar Server</title>
-
- <para>
- The personal calendar server (&PCS;) provides centralized
- management and storage of a user's personal calendar. Multiple
- clients can connect to the &PCS; simultaneously to query and
- modify the user's calendar in a synchronized fashion. The main
- features of the &PCS; are as follows:
- </para>
-
- <formalpara>
- <title>Storage</title>
-
- <para>
- The &PCS; is responsible for loading and saving calendars.
- Centralizing the loading and saving functionality allows
- multiple clients to use the same calendar at the same time
- without having to worry about each other.
- </para>
- </formalpara>
-
- <formalpara>
- <title>Basic Queries</title>
-
- <para>
- The &PCS; provides functions to do basic queries on a
- calendar, for example, a client can ask the server for a list
- of all the appointments in the calendar, or for all the data
- for a specific appointment.
- </para>
- </formalpara>
-
- <formalpara>
- <title>Recurrence and Alarm Queries</title>
-
- <para>
- Clients can ask the &PCS; for a list of the appointments that
- occur within a specified time range; for example a graphical
- client that has a per-week view could ask the &PCS; for all
- the appointments that occur in a particular week. This
- includes multiple occurrences of a single recurring event; for
- example, the object for &ldquo;a 1-hour meeting that occurs on
- every Tuesday and Thursday&rdquo; is represented inside the
- &PCS; as a single event with a recurrence rule. Similarly,
- clients can ask the &PCS; for a list of events that have
- alarms that trigger within a specified time range.
- </para>
- </formalpara>
-
- <formalpara>
- <title>Notification of Changes</title>
-
- <para>
- This is the most important function of the &PCS;, as it allows
- multiple calendar clients to maintain a unified view of the
- calendar between the server and themselves. When a client
- asks the &PCS; to modify or remove an event, the &PCS;
- notifies all the clients that are connected to it about the
- change. The policy is that &ldquo;the server is always
- right&rdquo;; clients can act as dumb views onto the
- calendar's data and they will be notified by the &PCS; when
- something changes.
- </para>
- </formalpara>
- </sect1>
-
- <!-- Calenar User Agent -->
-
- <sect1 id="cua">
- <title>Calendar User Agent</title>
-
- <para>
- A calendar user agent (&CUA;) is a program that lets a user
- manipulate a calendar. &Evolution; provides an attractive,
- graphical calendar client that communicates with the &Evolution;
- personal calendar server.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The &Evolution; calendar client just provides a view onto the
- data that is stored and managed by the personal calendar server.
- The calendar client does not perform direct manipulations on a
- calendar's data; instead it offloads those requests to the
- calendar server, which takes care of making the appropriate
- modifications in the calendar and then notifies all the clients
- about the changes.
- </para>
- </sect1>
-
- <!-- Calendar Client Library -->
-
- <sect1 id="client-lib">
- <title>Calendar Client Library</title>
-
- <para>
- Communication between the personal calendar server and calendar
- clients is defined by a set of &Bonobo; &CORBA; interfaces.
- Clients can be written by implementing the client-side
- <classname>Listener</classname> interface, which defines the
- notification callbacks that the PCS uses to inform clients about
- changes to the calendar.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- As a convenience for &GTK; programmers, &Evolution; also
- includes a library which provides a
- <classname>CalClient</classname> class which can be used for
- communication with the personal calendar server. Objects of
- this class automatically contact the PCS when they are created.
- <classname>CalClient</classname> provides functions to request
- changes in the calendar, and it also emits signals when it gets
- notification about changes from the PCS. This makes it easy and
- convenient to write calendar clients for &Evolution; using
- &GTK;.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The implementation of the <classname>CalClient</classname> class
- simply wraps the &Evolution; &CORBA; interfaces for calendaring
- with a familiar-looking &GTK; object. Calls to the
- <classname>Listener</classname> interface get translated to
- signal emissions from the <classname>CalClient</classname>, thus
- shielding programmers from the details of the &CORBA;
- interfaces.
- </para>
- </sect1>
-</article>
diff --git a/doc/white-papers/mail/camel.sgml b/doc/white-papers/mail/camel.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index a339909f54..0000000000
--- a/doc/white-papers/mail/camel.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,339 +0,0 @@
-<!doctype article PUBLIC "-//Davenport//DTD DocBook V3.0//EN" [
-<!entity Evolution "<application>Evolution</application>">
-<!entity Camel "Camel">
-]>
-
-<article class="whitepaper" id="camel">
-
- <artheader>
- <title>The &Camel; Messaging Library</title>
-
- <authorgroup>
- <author>
- <firstname>Dan</firstname>
- <surname>Winship</surname>
- <affiliation>
- <address>
- <email>danw@helixcode.com</email>
- </address>
- </affiliation>
- </author>
-
- <author>
- <firstname>Bertrand</firstname>
- <surname>Guiheneuf</surname>
- <affiliation>
- <address>
- <email>bertrand@helixcode.com</email>
- </address>
- </affiliation>
- </author>
- </authorgroup>
-
- <copyright>
- <year>2000</year>
- <holder>Helix Code, Inc.</holder>
- </copyright>
-
- </artheader>
-
- <sect1 id="introduction">
- <title>Introduction</title>
-
- <para>
- &Camel; is a generic messaging library. It is being used as the
- back end for the mail component of &Evolution;. The name
- "&Camel;" is an acronym; it refers to the fact that the
- library is capable of going several days without food or water.
- It means : Camel's Acronym Makes Everyone Laugh.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- &Camel;'s initial design is heavily based on Sun's
- <trademark>JavaMail</trademark> API. It uses the Gtk+ object
- system, and many of its classes are direct analags of JavaMail
- classes. Its design has also been influenced by the features of
- IMAP, and the limitations of the standard UNIX mbox mail store,
- which set some of the boundaries on its requirements and
- extensibility.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- &Camel; sees all message repositories as stores containing
- folders. These folders in turn contain the messages the client
- actually accesses. The use of such a unified interface allows
- the client applications to be very extensible. &Camel; includes
- an external provider mechanism which allows applications to
- dynamically load and use protocols which were not available when
- the application was initially written.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The abstract store/folder mechanism is a powerful and versatile
- way of accessing messages. No particular asumptions are made on
- the client side, thus allowing new ways of managing the
- messages. For example, the messages stored in the folders don't
- necessarily have to share some common physical location. The
- folder can be a purely virtual folder, containing only
- references to the actual messages. This is used by the "vFolder"
- provider, which allows you select messages meeting particular
- criteria and deal with them as a group.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- In addition to these possibilities, &Camel; has full MIME
- support. &Camel; MIME messages are lightweight objects
- representing the MIME skeleton of the actual message. The data
- contained in the subparts are never stored in memory except when
- they are actually needed. The application, when accessing the
- various MIME objects contained in the message (text parts,
- attachments, embedded binary objects ...) asks &Camel; for a
- stream that it can read data from. This scheme is particularly
- useful with the IMAP provider. IMAP has strong MIME support
- built-in, which allows &Camel; to download only the parts of
- messages that it actually needs: attachments need not be
- downloaded until they are viewed, and unnecessary
- "multipart/alternative" parts will never be read off the server.
- </para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="overview">
- <title>Overview</title>
-
- <graphic format="gif" fileref="camel"></graphic>
-
- <para>
- To begin using &Camel;, an application first creates a
- <classname>CamelSession</classname> object. This object is used
- to store application defaults, and to coordinate communication
- between providers and the application.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- A <classname>CamelProvider</classname> is a dynamically-loadable
- module that provides functionality associated with a specific
- service. Examples of providers are IMAP and SMTP. Providers
- include subclasses of the various other &Camel; classes for
- accessing and manipulating messages.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- <classname>CamelService</classname> is an abstract class for
- describing a connection to a local or remote service. It
- currently has two subclasses: <classname>CamelStore</classname>,
- for services that store messages (such as IMAP servers and mbox
- files), and <classname>CamelTransport</classname>, for services
- that deliver messages (such as SMTP, or a local MTA). A provider
- could also be both a store and a transport, as in the case of
- NNTP.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- A <classname>CamelStore</classname> contains some number of
- <classname>CamelFolder</classname> objects, which in turn
- contain messages. A <classname>CamelFolder</classname> provides
- a <classname>CamelFolderSummary</classname> object, which
- includes details about the subject, date, and sender of each
- message in the folder. The folder also includes the messages
- themselves, as subclasses of <classname>CamelMedium</classname>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Email messages are represented by the
- <classname>CamelMimeMessage</classname> class, a subclass of
- <classname>CamelMedium</classname>. This class includes
- operations for accessing RFC822 and MIME headers, accessing
- subparts of MIME messages, encoding and decoding Base64 and
- Quoted-Printable, etc.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- <classname>CamelTransport</classname> includes methods for
- delivering messages. While the abstract
- <function>CamelTransport::send</function> method takes a
- <classname>CamelMedium</classname>, its subclasses may only be
- able to deliver messages of specific
- <classname>CamelMedium</classname> subclasses. For instance,
- <classname>CamelSendmailTransport</classname> requires a
- <classname>CamelMimeMessage</classname>, because it needs a
- message that includes a "To:" header. A hypothetical
- <classname>CamelNNTPTransport</classname> would need a
- <classname>CamelNewsMessage</classname>, which would have a
- "Newsgroups:" header.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The content of messages are referred to using
- <classname>CamelStream</classname> and its subclasses. In the
- case of an mbox-based store, the
- <classname>CamelStream</classname> would abstract the operation
- of reading the correct section of the mbox file. For IMAP,
- reading off the <classname>CamelStream</classname> might result
- in commands being issued to the remote IMAP server and data
- being read off a socket.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The final major class in &Camel; is
- <classname>CamelException</classname>, which is used to
- propagate information about errors. Many methods take a
- <classname>CamelException</classname> as an argument, which the
- caller can then check if an error occurs. It includes both a
- numeric error code which can be interpreted by the program, and
- a text error message that can be displayed to the user.
- </para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="classes">
- <title>Major Subcomponents</title>
-
- <sect2 id="store">
- <title>The Message Store</title>
-
- <para>
- A <classname>CamelStore</classname> inherits the ability to
- connect and authenticate to a service from its parent class,
- <classname>CamelService</classname>. It then adds the ability
- to retrieve folders. A store must contain at least one folder,
- which can be retrieved with
- <function>CamelStore::get_default_folder</function>. There are
- also methods to retrieve the "top-level" folder (for
- hieararchical stores), and to retrieve an arbitrary folder by
- name.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- All <classname>CamelFolder</classname>s must implement certain
- core operations, most notably generating a summary and
- retrieving and deleting messages. A
- <classname>CamelFolder</classname> must assign a permanently
- unique identifier to each message it contains. Messages can
- then be retrieved via
- <function>CamelFolder::get_message_by_uid</function>. Alternately,
- within a single mail-reading session, messages can be referred
- to by their linear position within the store using
- <function>CamelFolder::get_message_by_number</function>.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Folders must also implement the
- <function>get_parent_folder</function> and
- <function>list_subfolders</function> methods. For stores that
- don't allow multiple folders, they would return NULL and an
- empty list, respectively. Stores that do allow multiple
- folders will also define methods for creating and deleting
- folders, and for moving messages between them (assuming the
- folders are writable).
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Folders that support searching can define the
- <function>search_by_expression</function> method. For mbox
- folders, this is implemented by indexing the messages with the
- ibex library and using that to search them later. For IMAP
- folders, this uses the IMAP SEARCH command. Other folder types
- might not be able to implement this functionality, in which
- case users would not be able to do full-content searches on
- them.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="messages">
- <title>Messages</title>
-
- <para>
- As mentioned before, messages are represented by subclasses of
- <classname>CamelMedium</classname>.
- <classname>CamelMedium</classname> itself is a subclass of
- <classname>CamelDataWrapper</classname>, a generic class for
- connecting a typed data source to a data sink.
- <classname>CamelMedium</classname> adds the concept of message
- headers versus message body.
- (<classname>CamelDataWrapper</classname> has one other
- important subclass, <classname>CamelMultipart</classname>,
- which is used to provide separate access to the multiple
- independent parts of a multipart MIME type.)
- <classname>CamelMedium</classname>'s subclasses provide more
- specialized handling of various headers:
- <classname>CamelMimePart</classname> adds special handling for
- the &ldquot;Content-*&rdquot; headers in MIME messages, and
- its subclass <classname>CamelMimeMessage</classname> adds
- handling for the RFC822 headers.
- </para>
-
- <graphic format="gif" fileref="mimemessage"></graphic>
-
- <para>
- Consider a message with two parts: a text part (in both plain
- text and HTML), and an attached image:
-
- <programlisting>
-
- From: Dan Winship &lt;danw@helixcode.com&gt;
- To: Matt Loper &lt;matt@helixcode.com&gt;
- Subject: the Camel white paper
- MIME-Version: 1.0
- Content-Type: multipart/mixed;
- boundary="jhTYrnsRrdhDFGa"
-
- This is a multi-part message in MIME format.
- --jhTYrnsRrdhDFGa
- Content-Type: multipart/alternative;
- boundary="sFSenbAFDSgDfg"
-
- --sFSenbAFDSgDfg
- Content-Type: text/plain
-
- Hey, Matt
-
- Check out this graphic...
-
- -- Dan
-
- --sFSenbAFDSgDfg
- Content-Type: text/html
-
- Hey, Matt&lt;br&gt;
- &lt;br&gt;
- Check out this graphic...&lt;br&gt;
- &lt;br&gt;
- -- Dan&lt;br&gt;
- &lt;br&gt;
- --sFSenbAFDSgDfg--
-
- --jhTYrnsRrdhDFGa
- Content-Type: image/png
- Content-Transfer-Encoding: base64
-
- F4JLw0ORrkRa8AwAMQJLAaI3UDIGsco9RAaB92...
- --jhTYrnsRrdhDFGa--
- </programlisting>
-
- <para>
- In &Camel;, this would be represented as follows:
- </para>
-
- <graphic fileref="samplemsg"></graphic>
- </sect2>
-
- <sect2 id="streams">
- <title>Streams</title>
-
- <para>
- Streams are a generic data transport layer. Two basic stream
- classes are <classname>CamelStreamFs</classname>, for
- reading and writing files, and
- <classname>CamelStreamMem</classname>, for reading from and
- writing to objects that are already in memory.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Streams can also be chained together. So a CamelMimePart
- containing base64-encoded data can filter its output through
- a CamelStreamB64. Other parts of the application that want
- to read its data will never need to even realize that the
- original data was encoded.
- </para>
- </sect2>
-
-</article>
diff --git a/doc/white-papers/mail/ibex.sgml b/doc/white-papers/mail/ibex.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index dcb8f5ca4b..0000000000
--- a/doc/white-papers/mail/ibex.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,158 +0,0 @@
-<!doctype article PUBLIC "-//Davenport//DTD DocBook V3.0//EN" [
-<!entity Evolution "<application>Evolution</application>">
-<!entity Camel "Camel">
-<!entity Ibex "Ibex">
-]>
-
-<article class="whitepaper" id="ibex">
-
- <artheader>
- <title>Ibex: an Indexing System</title>
-
- <authorgroup>
- <author>
- <firstname>Dan</firstname>
- <surname>Winship</surname>
- <affiliation>
- <address>
- <email>danw@helixcode.com</email>
- </address>
- </affiliation>
- </author>
- </authorgroup>
-
- <copyright>
- <year>2000</year>
- <holder>Helix Code, Inc.</holder>
- </copyright>
-
- </artheader>
-
- <sect1 id="introduction">
- <title>Introduction</title>
-
- <para>
- &Ibex; is a library for text indexing. It is being used by
- &Camel; to allow it to quickly search locally-stored messages,
- either because the user is looking for a specific piece of text,
- or because the application is contructing a vFolder or filtering
- incoming mail.
- </para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="goals">
- <title>Design Goals and Requirements for Ibex</title>
-
- <para>
- The design of &Ibex; is based on a number of requirements.
-
- <itemizedlist>
- <listitem>
- <para>
- First, obviously, it must be fast. In particular, searching
- the index must be appreciably faster than searching through
- the messages themselves, and constructing and maintaining
- the index must not take a noticeable amount of time.
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem>
- <para>
- The indexes must not take up too much space. Many users have
- limited filesystem quotas on the systems where they read
- their mail, and even users who read mail on private machines
- have to worry about running out of space on their disks. The
- indexes should be able to do their job without taking up so
- much space that the user decides he would be better off
- without them.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Another aspect of this problem is that the system as a whole
- must be clever about what it does and does not index:
- accidentally indexing a "text" mail message containing
- uuencoded, BinHexed, or PGP-encrypted data will drastically
- affect the size of the index file. Either the caller or the
- indexer itself has to avoid trying to index these sorts of
- things.
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem>
- <para>
- The indexing system must allow data to be added to the index
- incrementally, so that new messages can be added to the
- index (and deleted messages can be removed from it) without
- having to re-scan all existing messages.
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem>
- <para>
- It must allow the calling application to explain the
- structure of the data however it wants to, rather than
- requiring that the unit of indexing be individual files.
- This way, &Camel; can index a single mbox-format file and
- treat it as multiple messages.
- </para>
- </listitem>
-
- <listitem>
- <para>
- It must support non-ASCII text, given that many people send
- and receive non-English email, and even people who only
- speak English may receive email from people whose names
- cannot be written in the US-ASCII character set.
- </para>
- </listitem>
- </itemizedlist>
-
- <para>
- While there are a number of existing indexing systems, none of
- them met all (or even most) of our requirements.
- </para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="implementation">
- <title>The Implementation</title>
-
- <para>
- &Ibex; is still young, and many of the details of the current
- implementation are not yet finalized.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- With the current index file format, 13 megabytes of Info files
- can be indexed into a 371 kilobyte index file&mdash;a bit under
- 3% of the original size. This is reasonable, but making it
- smaller would be nice. (The file format includes some simple
- compression, but <application>gzip</application> can compress an
- index file to about half its size, so we can clearly do better.)
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The implementation has been profiled and optimized for speed to
- some degree. But, it has so far only been run on a 500MHz
- Pentium III system with very fast disks, so we have no solid
- benchmarks.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Further optimization (of both the file format and the in-memory
- data structures) awaits seeing how the library is most easily
- used by &Evolution;: if the indexes are likely to be kept in
- memory for long periods of time, the in-memory data structures
- need to be kept small, but the reading and writing operations
- can be slow. On the other hand, if the indexes will only be
- opened when they are needed, reading and writing must be fast,
- and memory usage is less critical.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Of course, to be useful for other applications that have
- indexing needs, the library should provide several options, so
- that each application can use the library in the way that is
- most suited for its needs.
- </para>
- </sect1>
-</article>
diff --git a/doc/white-papers/widgets/e-table.sgml b/doc/white-papers/widgets/e-table.sgml
deleted file mode 100644
index 5ff4faf2ae..0000000000
--- a/doc/white-papers/widgets/e-table.sgml
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,279 +0,0 @@
-<!doctype article PUBLIC "-//Davenport//DTD DocBook V3.0//EN" [
-<!entity Evolution "<application>Evolution</application>">
-<!entity ETable "<classname>ETable</classname>">
-<!entity ETableModel "<classname>ETableModel</classname>">
-<!entity ETableSimple "<classname>ETableSimple</classname>">
-<!entity ETableHeader "<classname>ETableHeader</classname>">
-<!entity ETableSpecification "<classname>ETableSpecification</classname>">
-<!entity ETableCol "<classname>ETableCol</classname>">
-]>
-
-<article class="whitepaper" id="e-table">
-
- <artheader>
- <title>The ETable Widget</title>
-
- <authorgroup>
- <author>
- <firstname>Chris</firstname>
- <surname>Lahey</surname>
- <affiliation>
- <address>
- <email>clahey@helixcode.com</email>
- </address>
- </affiliation>
- </author>
- <author>
- <firstname>Miguel</firstname>
- <surname>de Icaza</surname>
- <affiliation>
- <address>
- <email>miguel@helixcode.com</email>
- </address>
- </affiliation>
- </author>
- </authorgroup>
-
- <copyright>
- <year>2000</year>
- <holder>Helix Code, Inc.</holder>
- </copyright>
-
- </artheader>
-
- <sect1 id="introduction">
- <title>Introduction</title>
-
- <para>
- &ETable; is a table widget on steroids. It is intended to provide
- all the table functionality needed throughout &Evolution;, and
- hopefully be general purpose enough to be used in other projects.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- &ETable; provides a lot of interactive control over the data in the
- table. Without any work from the programmer, &ETable; provides
- rearrangeable columns and editable data. When finished, &ETable; will
- also provide, again with no programmer intervention, easy interactive
- sorting and grouping.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- &ETable; gives you a great deal of functionality, flexibility, and
- power. Most of this power is internal to the widget, but some of
- the flexibility requires a bit of work by the programmer.
- However, once you learn it, &ETable; is not very hard at all to
- use.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- &ETable;'s power comes from the fact that it is fully
- model/view/controller based. Various models are involved into
- the process of rendering the information, and various views are
- provided. The programmer has a wide range of options: from the
- most finely hand-tuned table to a generic all-encompasing widget
- that takes over most of tasks. It is up to the programmer: he
- can use the simple to use &ETable; widget that takes care of
- everything in a generic way, or he can use the various
- components to roll his own tabular display.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- &ETable; ships with a standard set of information renderers:
- strings, bitmaps, toggle-buttons, check-boxes, and multi-line
- strings. But the programmer can write and implement his own
- renderer for his information. This means that by default
- &ETable; provides the basic display facilities that programmers
- required, but they offer the programmer a complete freedom to
- incorporate new cell renderers.
- </para>
-
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="model">
- <title>ETableModel</title>
-
- <para>
- The data back end for the &ETable; is an &ETableModel;. The
- &ETableModel is an abstract interface that acts as the
- information repository for the various &ETable components.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- To use &ETable; you have to create a subclass of the abstract
- &ETableModel; class. However, to save you the work of defining
- a new <classname>GtkClass</classname> every time you use
- &ETable, there is a predefined subclass of &ETableModel; called
- &ETableSimple; which simply takes a list of function callbacks
- to perform the various operations.
- </para>
-
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="columns">
- <title>Columns</title>
-
- <para>
- There are two different meanings to the word "column". The first
- is the model column (defined by the &ETableCol: object). A model
- column describes how it maps to the column in the &ETableModel;
- as well as containing information about its properties (name,
- resizability, resize dimensions, and a renderer for this
- specific columns).
- </para>
-
- <para>
- &ETable; distinguishes between a model column index, and a view
- column index. The former reflects the column in which the data
- is stored in the &ETableModel; The later represents the actual
- location at which the column is being displayed in the screen.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- Each view column index corresponds to a specific model column,
- though a model column may have any number of view columns
- associated with it (including zero). For example the same
- column might be rendered twice, or the data from one column
- could be used to display different bits of information
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The view column does not necessarily depend on only one model
- column. In some cases, the view column renderer can be given a
- reference to another model column to get extra information about
- its display. For example, a mail program could display deleted
- messages with a line through them by creating a model column
- with no corresponding view column that told whether or not the
- message is deleted, and then having the text column
- strikethrough the display if the invisible column had a value
- corresponding to "deleted".
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The view column also specifies a few other pieces of
- information. One piece of information is the renderer. &ETable;
- provides a number of renderers to choose from, or you can write
- your own. Currently, there are renderers for text, image sets,
- and checkboxes.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The view column also includes information about the header.
- There are two types of headers: text, and pixbuf. The first
- allows you to specify a string which is rendered in the header.
- The second allows you to specify an image to copy into the
- header.
- </para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="header">
- <title>Header</title>
-
- <para>
- The &ETableHeader; represents the header information for the
- table. The &ETableHeader; is used in two different ways. The
- first is the in the <structfield>full_header</structfield>
- element of an &ETable;. This is the list of possible columns in
- the view. You add each of your columns to this &ETableHeader;
- and then pass it into the &ETable;.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The second use is completely internal. &ETable; uses another
- &ETableHeader; to store the actual displayed columns. Many of
- the &ETableHeader; functions are for this purpose. The only
- functions that users of the library should need to use are
- <function>e_table_header_new</function> and
- <function>e_table_header_add_col</function>.
- </para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="layout">
- <title>Layout Specification</title>
-
- <para>
- &ETable; uses an &ETableSpecification; to layout the columns of
- the widget. The &ETableSpecification; is specified as XML data
- passed into the &ETable; as a string.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The most powerful part of the &ETableSpecification; is that when
- finished, &ETable; will allow you to get a copy of an
- &ETableSpecification; that describes the current view of the
- tree. This allows the developer to save the current view so that
- next time the user opens this table, they find it in exactly the
- state that they left it.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The XML specification allows for a number of things. First, it
- allows you to pick a set of default columns to be shown. Thus,
- even if you had hundreds of pieces of data, you could choose to
- only display a few that fit on the screen by default.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The second major thing that the &ETableSpecification; allows you
- to specify is the column grouping and sorting. &ETable; has a
- powerful mechanism for allowing the user to choose columns to
- group by, thus allowing multiple columns of sorting, as well as
- visual grouping of similar elements and interactive selection of
- what data to display.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- The grouping in &ETableSpecification; is specified as a
- hierarchy of columns to group by. Each level of the hierarchy
- lets you sort by a particular column, either ascending or
- descending. All levels except the last cause the canvas to group
- by the given column.
- </para>
-
- <para>
- An example &ETableSpecification; follows.
- </para>
-
- <programlisting>
- &lt;ETableSpecification&gt;
- &lt;columns-shown frozen_columns="2"&gt;
- &lt;column&gt; 0 &lt;/column&gt;
- &lt;column&gt; 1 &lt;/column&gt;
- &lt;column&gt; 2 &lt;/column&gt;
- &lt;column&gt; 3 &lt;/column&gt;
- &lt;column&gt; 4 &lt;/column&gt;
- &lt;/columns-shown&gt;
- &lt;grouping&gt;
- &lt;group column="3" ascending="1"&gt;
- &lt;group column="4" ascending="0"&gt;
- &lt;leaf column="2" ascending="1"/&gt;
- &lt;/group&gt;
- &lt;/group&gt;
- &lt;/grouping&gt;
- &lt;/ETableSpecification&gt;
- </programlisting>
-
- <para>
- This example has 5 columns which are initially in order. It has
- 2 levels of grouping. The first is grouped by the 4th column
- (all indexes are 0 based) and sorts those groups in ascending
- order. Inside those groups, the data is grouped by the fifth
- column and sorted in descending order of the fifth column.
- Finally, the data in those groups is sorted by the third column
- in ascending order. Due to the "frozen_columns" attribute on the
- columns-shown element, the user will not be
- able to rearrange the first two columns. They will always be the
- first two.
- </para>
- </sect1>
-
- <sect1 id="conclusion">
- <title>Conclusion</title>
-
- <para>
- All in all, &ETable; is a very powerful widget. Once you learn
- to use it, you have access to a vast amount of power requiring a
- comparatively small amount of work.
- </para>
- </sect1>
-</article>